Furuno USA 9ZWRTR079A Marine Radar User Manual FAR2xx7 OME
Furuno USA Inc Marine Radar FAR2xx7 OME
Contents
- 1. op manual
- 2. Inst manual part 1
- 3. Inst manual part 2
op manual
OPERATOR'S MANUAL MARINE RADAR/ARPA MODEL FAR-28x7 Series FAR-21x7(-BB) Series Complies with IMO MSC.192(79) www.furuno.co.jp IMPORTANT NOTICES General • The operator of this equipment must read and follow the descriptions in this manual. Wrong operation or maintenance can cancel the warranty or cause injury. • Do not copy any part of this manual without written permission from FURUNO. • If this manual is lost or worn, contact your dealer about replacement. • The contents of this manual and equipment specifications can change without notice. • The example screens (or illustrations) shown in this manual can be different from the screens you see on your display. The screens you see depend on your system configuration and equipment settings. • Save this manual for future reference. • Any modification of the equipment (including software) by persons not authorized by FURUNO will cancel the warranty. • All brand and product names are trademarks, registered trademarks or service marks of their respective holders. How to discard this product Discard this product according to local regulations for the disposal of industrial waste. For disposal in the USA, see the homepage of the Electronics Industries Alliance (http://www.eiae.org/) for the correct method of disposal. How to discard a used battery Some FURUNO products have a battery(ies). To see if your product has a battery, see the chapter on Maintenance. Follow the instructions below if a battery is used. Tape the + and terminals of battery before disposal to prevent fire, heat generation caused by short circuit. In the European Union The crossed-out trash can symbol indicates that all types of batteries must not be discarded in standard trash, or at a trash site. Take the used batteries to a battery collection site according to your national legislation and the Batteries Directive 2006/66/EU. Cd In the USA The Mobius loop symbol (three chasing arrows) indicates that Ni-Cd and lead-acid rechargeable batteries must be recycled. Take the used batteries to a battery collection site according to local laws. Ni-Cd Pb In the other countries There are no international standards for the battery recycle symbol. The number of symbols can increase when the other countries make their own recycling symbols in the future. SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS The operator and installer must read the applicable safety instructions before attempting to install or operate the equipment. DANGER Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury. WARNING Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury. CAUTION Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, can result in minor or moderate injury. Warning, Caution Mandatory Action Prohibitive Action WARNING Radio Frequency Radiation Hazard The radar antenna emits electromagnetic radio frequency (RF) energy which can be harmful, particularly to your eyes. Never look directly into the antenna aperture from a close distance while the radar ius in operation or eexpose yourself to the transmitting antenna at a close distance. Distances at which RF radiation level of 100, 50 and 10 W/m 2 are given in the table below. Note: If the antenna unit is installed at a close distance in front of the wheel house, your administration may require halt of transmission within a certain sector of antenna revolution. This is possible. Ask your FURUNO representive or dealer to provide this feature. Radar model Transceiver Magnetron FAR-2117/2817 RTR-078A MAF-1565N FAR-2127/2827 RTR-079A MG5436 FAR-2137S/2837S RTR-080 FAR-2827W FAR-2837SW *1 ii MG5223F RTR-081A MG5436 RTR-082 MG5223F Antenna XN12AF XN20AF XN24AF XN12AF XN20AF XN24AF SN30AF SN36AF XN20AF XN24AF SN36AF *1 100W/m 0.3m 0.1m 0.1m 0.9m 0.5m 0.2m 0.1m 0.1m 0.4m 0.2m 50W/m 2 10W/m 2 1.2m 0.7m 0.4m 2.6m 1.7m 1.0m 3.7m 2.2m 1.5m 9.0m 4.6m 3.3m 0.7m 1.0m 0.5m 0.2m 2.4m 2.0m 5.6m 3.4m 1.9m XN12AF: 120cm, XN20AF: 198cm, XN24AF: 243cm, SN30AF: 309cm, SN36AF: 377cm SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS WARNING ELECTRICAL SHOCK HAZARD WARNING Use the proper fuse. Do not open the equipment. Only qualified personnel should work inside the equipment. Turn off the radar power switch before servicing the antenna unit. Post a warning sign near the switch indicating it should not be turned on while the antenna unit is being serviced. Prevent the potential risk of being struck by the rotating antenna and exposure to RF radiation hazard. Wear a safety belt and hard hat when working on the antenna unit. Serious injury or death can result if someone falls from the radar antenna mast. Use of a wrong fuse can result in damage to the equipment or cause fire. Keep heater away from equipment. Heat can alter equipment shape and melt the power cord, which can cause fire or electrical shock. Do not place liquid-filled containers near the equipment. Fire or electrical shock can result if a liquid spills into the equipment. Do not operate the equipment with wet hands. Electrical shock can result. Before servicing the radar, turn off the appropriate external breaker. Power is not removed from the radar simply by turning off its power switch. Do not disassemble or modify the equipment. Fire, electrical shock or serious injury can result. Immediately turn off the power at the ship's mains switchboard if water leaks into the equipment or the equipment is emitting smoke or fire. Continued use can cause fatal damage to the equipment. iii SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS CAUTION WARNING No one navigational aid should be relied upon for the safety of vessel and crew. The navigator has the responsibility to check all aids available to confirm position. Electronic aids are not a substitute for basic navigational principles and common sense. • This TT automatically tracks automatically or manually acquired radar targets and calculates their courses and speeds, indicating them by vectors. Since the data generated by the auto plotter are based on what radar targets are selected, the radar must always be optimally tuned for use with the auto plotter, to ensure required targets will not be lost or unwanted targets such as sea returns and noise will not be acquired and tracked. • A target does not always mean a landmass, reef, ships or other surface vessels but can imply returns from sea surface and clutter. As the level of clutter changes with environment, the operator should properly adjust the A/C SEA, A/C RAIN and GAIN controls to be sure target echoes are not eliminated from the radar screen. The plotting accuracy and response of this TT meets IMO standards. Tracking accuracy is affected by the following: • Tracking accuracy is affected by course change. One to two minutes is required to restore vectors to full accuracy after an abrupt course change. (The actual amount depends on gyrocompass specifications.) • The amount of tracking delay is inversely proportional to the relative speed of the target. Delay is on the order of 15—30 seconds for high relative speed; 30—60 seconds for low relative speed. • Display accuracy is affected by the following: - Echo intensity - Radar transmission pulsewidth - Radar bearing error - Gyrocompass error - Course change (own ship and target) The data generated by TT, AIS and video plotter are intended for reference only. Refer to official nautical charts for detailed and up-to-date information. WARNING LABEL Warning labels are attached to the equipment. Do not remove any label. If a label is missing or damaged, contact a FURUNO agent or dealer about replacement. WARNING To avoid electrical shock, do not remove cover. No user-serviceable parts inside. WARNING Radiation hazard. Only qualified personnel should work inside scanner. Confirm that TX has stopped before opening scanner. iv DISPLAY UNIT, PROCESSOR UNIT Name: Warning Label (1) Type: 86-003-1011-1 Code No.: 100-236-231 ANTENNA UNIT Name: Radiation Warning Label 03-142-3201-0 Type: Code No.: 100-266-890 TABLE OF CONTENTS FOREWORD ........................................................................................................ xi PROGRAM NUMBER ......................................................................................... xv SYSTEM CONFIGURATION.............................................................................. xvi 1. RADAR OPERATION.................................................................................... 1-1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 1.9 1.10 1.11 1.12 1.13 1.14 1.15 1.16 1.17 1.18 1.19 1.20 1.21 Turning on the Power .................................................................................................. 1-1 Transmitter ON ............................................................................................................ 1-1 Control Unit ................................................................................................................. 1-3 Main Menu................................................................................................................... 1-5 Operation by the On-Screen Boxes ............................................................................ 1-7 Cursor Menu.............................................................................................................. 1-10 Monitor Brilliance........................................................................................................1-11 Display Modes ........................................................................................................... 1-12 On-Screen Boxes and Markers ................................................................................. 1-13 Tuning the Receiver .................................................................................................. 1-15 1.10.1 Choosing the tuning method........................................................................... 1-15 1.10.2 Initializing tuning ............................................................................................. 1-15 1.10.3 Automatic tuning ............................................................................................. 1-16 1.10.4 Manual tuning ................................................................................................. 1-16 Aligning Heading with Gyrocompass......................................................................... 1-16 Presentation Modes................................................................................................... 1-17 1.12.1 Choosing presentation mode .......................................................................... 1-17 1.12.2 Description of presentation modes ................................................................. 1-18 Entering Own Ship's Speed....................................................................................... 1-22 1.13.1 Automatic speed input by log or GPS navigator ............................................. 1-22 1.13.2 Manual speed input ........................................................................................ 1-23 Choosing a Range Scale........................................................................................... 1-23 Choosing a Pulselength ............................................................................................ 1-24 1.15.1 Choosing a pulselength .................................................................................. 1-24 1.15.2 Changing pulselength ..................................................................................... 1-25 Adjusting the Sensitivity ............................................................................................ 1-26 Reducing Sea Clutter ................................................................................................ 1-27 1.17.1 Choosing method of adjustment ..................................................................... 1-27 1.17.2 Automatic reduction of sea clutter .................................................................. 1-27 1.17.3 Manual reduction of sea clutter....................................................................... 1-28 Reducing Rain Clutter ............................................................................................... 1-29 1.18.1 Automatic reduction of rain clutter .................................................................. 1-29 1.18.2 Manual reduction of rain clutter ...................................................................... 1-29 Measuring Range ...................................................................................................... 1-31 1.19.1 Showing, hiding the fixed range rings............................................................. 1-31 1.19.2 Measuring range by the variable range marker (VRM)................................... 1-32 1.19.3 VRM unit of measurement (B and C types) .................................................... 1-33 1.19.4 TTG to VRM indication ................................................................................... 1-33 Measuring Bearing .................................................................................................... 1-34 1.20.1 Measuring bearing .......................................................................................... 1-34 1.20.2 True or relative bearing................................................................................... 1-35 Collision Assessment by Offset EBL ......................................................................... 1-36 1.21.1 How to assess risk of collision by the offset EBL............................................ 1-36 1.21.2 Point of reference for origin point of offset EBL .............................................. 1-37 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1.22 Measuring Range and Bearing Between Two Targets ...............................................1-38 1.23 Target Alarm ...............................................................................................................1-39 1.23.1 How to set a target alarm ................................................................................1-39 1.23.2 Acknowledging the target alarm ......................................................................1-40 1.23.3 Deactivating a target alarm..............................................................................1-40 1.23.4 Target alarm attributes.....................................................................................1-41 1.24 Off-Centering the Display...........................................................................................1-42 1.25 Interference Rejector..................................................................................................1-43 1.26 Echo Stretch...............................................................................................................1-43 1.27 Echo Averaging ..........................................................................................................1-44 1.28 Noise Rejector............................................................................................................1-45 1.29 Wiper..........................................................................................................................1-46 1.30 Target Trails................................................................................................................1-47 1.30.1 True or relative trails........................................................................................1-47 1.30.2 Trail time..........................................................................................................1-48 1.30.3 Trail gradation..................................................................................................1-48 1.30.4 Saving, copying target trails ............................................................................1-49 1.30.5 Trail level .........................................................................................................1-50 1.30.6 Narrow trails (B, C and W types) .....................................................................1-50 1.30.7 Longer trails (B, C and W types) .....................................................................1-51 1.30.8 Temporarily removing trails from the display ...................................................1-51 1.30.9 Trail stabilization in true motion .......................................................................1-51 1.30.10 Erasing trails ..................................................................................................1-51 1.31 PI (Parallel Index) Lines .............................................................................................1-52 1.31.1 Displaying, erasing PI lines .............................................................................1-52 1.31.2 Adjusting PI line orientation, PI line interval ....................................................1-53 1.31.3 PI line bearing reference .................................................................................1-53 1.31.4 Maximum number of PI lines to display...........................................................1-54 1.31.5 PI line orientation.............................................................................................1-54 1.31.6 Resetting PI lines ............................................................................................1-54 1.32 Origin Mark.................................................................................................................1-55 1.32.1 Entering origin marks ......................................................................................1-55 1.32.2 Origin mark stabilization ..................................................................................1-57 1.32.3 Deleting individual origin marks.......................................................................1-57 1.33 Zoom ..........................................................................................................................1-58 1.34 Markers ......................................................................................................................1-59 1.34.1 Heading line ....................................................................................................1-59 1.34.2 Stern marker....................................................................................................1-59 1.34.3 North marker ...................................................................................................1-59 1.34.4 Own ship symbol .............................................................................................1-60 1.34.5 Barge marker...................................................................................................1-61 1.34.6 INS marker ......................................................................................................1-61 1.35 Automatic Picture Setup According to Navigation Purpose .......................................1-62 1.35.1 Selecting a picture setup option ......................................................................1-64 1.35.2 Programming and saving picture setups .........................................................1-64 1.35.3 Restoring user settings....................................................................................1-66 1.35.4 Restoring default picture setup options ...........................................................1-66 1.35.5 Disabling unnecessary picture setups .............................................................1-67 1.36 Function Keys ............................................................................................................1-68 1.36.1 Activating function keys...................................................................................1-68 1.36.2 Programming function keys .............................................................................1-68 1.37 Ship’s Position............................................................................................................1-72 1.38 Second-trace Echoes.................................................................................................1-74 vi TABLE OF CONTENTS 1.39 1.40 1.41 1.42 1.43 1.44 Brilliance of Screen Data ........................................................................................... 1-75 Watch Alarm .............................................................................................................. 1-76 Nav Data ................................................................................................................... 1-77 Text Window .............................................................................................................. 1-79 Customizing Operation .............................................................................................. 1-81 Alert Box.................................................................................................................... 1-83 1.44.1 Alarm description ............................................................................................ 1-84 1.44.2 Alarm list ......................................................................................................... 1-87 1.44.3 Outputting alarm signals ................................................................................. 1-88 1.44.4 Primary alarm ................................................................................................. 1-89 1.45 Interswitch ................................................................................................................. 1-90 1.45.1 Displaying antenna information ...................................................................... 1-90 1.45.2 Presetting antenna and display combinations ................................................ 1-91 1.45.3 Selecting an antenna ...................................................................................... 1-93 1.46 Cursor Data ............................................................................................................... 1-93 1.47 Performance Monitor ................................................................................................. 1-94 1.47.1 Activating, deactivating the performance monitor........................................... 1-94 1.47.2 Checking radar performance .......................................................................... 1-94 1.48 Own Ship Marker....................................................................................................... 1-96 1.49 Color and Brilliance Sets ........................................................................................... 1-97 1.49.1 Selecting color and brilliance set .................................................................... 1-97 1.49.2 Presetting color and brilliance set................................................................... 1-97 1.50 Reference Position .................................................................................................... 1-99 1.51 Switching Hub HUB-100 (option) ............................................................................ 1-101 1.52 Anchor Watch.......................................................................................................... 1-102 1.53 Drop Mark................................................................................................................ 1-103 1.53.1 Activating the drop mark feature................................................................... 1-103 1.53.2 Inscribing a drop mark .................................................................................. 1-104 1.53.3 Erasing a drop mark ..................................................................................... 1-104 1.54 Sub Monitor (B, C and W types) .............................................................................. 1-105 1.55 Net Cursor ............................................................................................................... 1-106 2. RADAR OBSERVATION ............................................................................... 2-1 2.1 General........................................................................................................................ 2-1 2.1.1 Minimum and maximum ranges........................................................................ 2-1 2.2 False Echoes............................................................................................................... 2-3 2.3 SART (Search and Rescue Transponder)................................................................... 2-5 2.3.1 SART description .............................................................................................. 2-5 2.3.2 Showing SART marks on the radar display ...................................................... 2-6 2.3.3 General remarks on receiving SARTs............................................................... 2-7 2.4 RACON ....................................................................................................................... 2-8 2.5 Radar Target Enhancer (RTE)..................................................................................... 2-8 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT)............................................................................. 3-1 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 Usage Precautions ...................................................................................................... 3-1 Controls for TT............................................................................................................. 3-2 Activating, Deactivating TT.......................................................................................... 3-3 Entering Own Ship's Speed......................................................................................... 3-3 3.4.1 Echo-referenced speed input............................................................................ 3-3 3.5 Automatic Acquisition .................................................................................................. 3-5 3.5.1 Enabling auto acquisition.................................................................................. 3-5 3.5.2 Terminating tracking of targets (including reference targets) ............................ 3-6 vii TABLE OF CONTENTS 3.6 Manual Acquisition .......................................................................................................3-7 3.6.1 Setting manual acquisition conditions ...............................................................3-7 3.6.2 Manually acquiring targets.................................................................................3-7 3.7 Lost Target ...................................................................................................................3-9 3.7.1 Setting the lost target filter.................................................................................3-9 3.7.2 Enabling, disabling the lost target alarm............................................................3-9 3.8 TT Symbols and Attributes .........................................................................................3-10 3.8.1 TT symbols ......................................................................................................3-10 3.8.2 Choosing TT symbol (B, C and W types) ........................................................ 3-11 3.8.3 TT symbol brilliance......................................................................................... 3-11 3.8.4 TT symbol color ...............................................................................................3-12 3.9 Displaying Target Data ...............................................................................................3-13 3.9.1 Displaying target data......................................................................................3-13 3.9.2 Target list .........................................................................................................3-15 3.10 Vector Modes .............................................................................................................3-16 3.10.1 Description of vectors ......................................................................................3-16 3.10.2 Vector mode and length ..................................................................................3-17 3.11 Past Position Display .................................................................................................3-18 3.11.1 Displaying and erasing past position points, choosing past position plot interval.........................................................................................3-18 3.11.2 Past position display attributes ........................................................................3-19 3.11.3 Past position display mode..............................................................................3-19 3.11.4 Stabilization in true mode ................................................................................3-20 3.12 Set and Drift ...............................................................................................................3-20 3.13 TT Collision Alarm (CPA, TCPA) ................................................................................3-21 3.13.1 Setting the CPA and TCPA ranges ..................................................................3-21 3.13.2 Acknowledging the TT collision alarm .............................................................3-22 3.14 Acquisition Zone.........................................................................................................3-22 3.14.1 Activating an acquisition zone .........................................................................3-22 3.14.2 Sleeping, deactivating an acquisition zone......................................................3-23 3.14.3 Acknowledging the alarm ................................................................................3-23 3.14.4 Acquisition zone reference ..............................................................................3-24 3.14.5 Acquisition zone shape and stabilization.........................................................3-24 3.15 TT System Messages ................................................................................................3-25 3.16 Trial Maneuver ...........................................................................................................3-26 3.16.1 Types of trial maneuvers .................................................................................3-26 3.16.2 Performing a trial maneuver ............................................................................3-27 3.16.3 Terminating a trial maneuver ...........................................................................3-29 3.17 TT Performance Test..................................................................................................3-30 3.18 Criteria for Selecting Targets for Tracking ..................................................................3-32 3.19 Factors Affecting TT Functions...................................................................................3-34 4. AIS OPERATION........................................................................................... 4-1 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 Controls for AIS ............................................................................................................4-1 Showing, Hiding the AIS Display..................................................................................4-2 AIS Display Filter..........................................................................................................4-4 Activating Targets.........................................................................................................4-5 4.4.1 Activating specific targets manually...................................................................4-5 4.4.2 Activating all targets ..........................................................................................4-5 4.5 How to Sleep Targets ...................................................................................................4-6 4.5.1 Sleeping an individual target .............................................................................4-6 4.5.2 Sleeping all targets ............................................................................................4-6 4.6 Setting Up for a Voyage ...............................................................................................4-7 viii TABLE OF CONTENTS 4.7 Target Data .................................................................................................................. 4-9 4.7.1 Basic target data ............................................................................................... 4-9 4.7.2 Detailed target data......................................................................................... 4-10 4.7.3 Removing a target data display ...................................................................... 4-10 4.7.4 Canceling tracking on a target from target data display.................................. 4-10 4.8 AIS Symbol Attributes.................................................................................................4-11 4.8.1 AIS symbol brilliance .......................................................................................4-11 4.8.2 AIS symbol size and color ...............................................................................4-11 4.9 Past Position Display................................................................................................. 4-12 4.9.1 Past position plot interval................................................................................ 4-12 4.9.2 Past position points......................................................................................... 4-13 4.9.3 Past position display motion ........................................................................... 4-13 4.9.4 Stabilization in true motion.............................................................................. 4-13 4.10 Lost Target................................................................................................................. 4-14 4.10.1 Lost target filter ............................................................................................... 4-14 4.10.2 Enabling, disabling the lost target alarm ......................................................... 4-15 4.11 ROT Setting............................................................................................................... 4-16 4.12 AIS Collision Alarm (CPA, TCPA) .............................................................................. 4-17 4.12.1 Setting the CPA and TCPA ranges.................................................................. 4-17 4.12.2 Enabling, disabling the AIS collision alarm ..................................................... 4-17 4.12.3 Limiting the function of the collision alarm ...................................................... 4-18 4.13 Association of TT and AIS Targets............................................................................. 4-19 4.14 Own Ship’s Data........................................................................................................ 4-21 4.15 Messages .................................................................................................................. 4-22 4.15.1 Creating, saving messages ............................................................................ 4-22 4.15.2 Transmitting messages................................................................................... 4-23 4.15.3 Viewing messages .......................................................................................... 4-24 4.16 AIS System Messages .............................................................................................. 4-26 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION.................................................................... 5-1 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 5.7 5.8 5.9 General........................................................................................................................ 5-1 Display Modes ............................................................................................................. 5-1 Presentation Modes..................................................................................................... 5-2 Radar Map................................................................................................................... 5-3 5.4.1 Showing, hiding the radar map display............................................................. 5-3 5.4.2 Inscribing radar map marks and lines ............................................................... 5-4 Erasing Radar Map Marks and Lines .......................................................................... 5-6 5.5.1 Erasing individual radar map marks and lines .................................................. 5-6 5.5.2 Erasing all radar map marks and lines ............................................................. 5-7 Radar Map Corrections ............................................................................................... 5-8 5.6.1 Radar map correction ....................................................................................... 5-8 5.6.2 Cursor data correction ...................................................................................... 5-8 Chart Cards (A, B, C and W types) ............................................................................. 5-9 5.7.1 Displaying a chart ............................................................................................. 5-9 5.7.2 Chart position correction................................................................................. 5-10 5.7.3 Correcting cursor data .................................................................................... 5-10 5.7.4 Chart land color (B, C and W types) ................................................................5-11 Hiding, Showing Graphics on the Video Plotter Display............................................ 5-12 Track.......................................................................................................................... 5-13 5.9.1 Plotting own ship’s track ................................................................................. 5-13 5.9.2 Plotting interval for other ships' tracks ............................................................ 5-14 5.9.3 Auto target track (A, B, C and W types).......................................................... 5-15 5.9.4 Choosing track color (A, B, C and W types) ................................................... 5-15 ix TABLE OF CONTENTS 5.10 5.11 5.12 5.13 5.14 5.9.5 Erasing track from the menu, on the screen....................................................5-16 5.9.6 Erasing track with the cursor ...........................................................................5-17 Waypoints ..................................................................................................................5-18 5.10.1 Entering waypoints ..........................................................................................5-18 5.10.2 Editing, erasing waypoints from the menu.......................................................5-20 5.10.3 Erasing waypoints ...........................................................................................5-21 5.10.4 Waypoint list ....................................................................................................5-22 5.10.5 Displaying waypoint name and number...........................................................5-23 Nav Lines ...................................................................................................................5-24 5.11.1 Entering a new nav line ...................................................................................5-24 5.11.2 Editing a nav line .............................................................................................5-25 5.11.3 Nav line list ......................................................................................................5-26 5.11.4 Erasing a nav line............................................................................................5-27 5.11.5 Setting up nav lines .........................................................................................5-28 5.11.6 Displaying nav line, waypoint mark .................................................................5-30 Recording Data ..........................................................................................................5-32 5.12.1 Initializing memory (RAM) cards......................................................................5-32 5.12.2 Recording data ................................................................................................5-33 Replaying Data...........................................................................................................5-35 Deleting Files .............................................................................................................5-36 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING...................................................... 6-1 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 6.5 6.6 6.7 6.8 Periodic Maintenance Schedule...................................................................................6-2 Life Expectancy of Major Parts ....................................................................................6-3 Replacing the Fuse ......................................................................................................6-4 Replacement of Battery on GC Board..........................................................................6-4 Trackball Maintenance .................................................................................................6-5 Easy Troubleshooting...................................................................................................6-6 Advanced-level Troubleshooting ..................................................................................6-7 Diagnostics.................................................................................................................6-10 APPENDIX ...................................................................................................... AP-1 1. Menu Tree ..................................................................................................................... AP-1 2. Digital Interface.............................................................................................................. AP-8 3. Parts Lists and Parts Location..................................................................................... AP-30 4. Longitude Error Table (on 96 nm range scale) ............................................................ AP-46 5. Abbreviations...............................................................................................................AP-48 6. Symbols....................................................................................................................... AP-50 SPECIFICATIONS........................................................................................... SP-1 INDEX............................................................................................................... IN-1 Declaration of Conformity FOREWORD A Word to the Owner of the FAR-28x7/FAR-21x7(-BB) Congratulations on your choice of the FURUNO FAR-28x7/FAR-21x7(-BB) Series Radar and TT. We are confident you will see why FURUNO has become synonymous with quality and reliability. For 60 years FURUNO Electric Company has enjoyed an enviable reputation for innovative and dependable marine electronics equipment. This dedication to excellence is furthered by our extensive global network of agents and dealers. Your radar is designed and constructed to meet the rigorous demands of the marine environment. However, no machine can perform its intended function unless installed, operated and maintained properly. Please carefully read and follow the recommended procedures for operation and maintenance. We would appreciate hearing from you, the end-user, about whether we are achieving our purposes. Thank you for considering and purchasing FURUNO equipment. Features • High-resolution 20.1-inch LCD (FR-21x7) or 23.1-inch LCD (FR-28x7). • This series of radar and TT* (Target Tracking) are available in the models shown in the table below. "BB" indicates blackbox configuration (monitor to be supplied locally) is available. * Formerly called "ARPA". X-band Model Output FAR-2117(-BB) 12 kW FAR-2127(-BB) 25 kW FAR-2817 12 kW FAR-2827 25 kW TR config. UP UP UP UP FAR-2827W DOWN 25 kW S-band Model Output FAR-2137S(-BB) 30 kW FAR-2837S 30 kW FAR-2837SW 30 kW FAR-2837SW 30 kW TR config. UP UP DOWN DOWN • Two types of trackball-equipped control units are available: RCU-014 (full keyboard) and the RCU-015 (palm control). The trackball is easy to use thanks to the ergonomically designed palm rest. • Simplified operation with point-and-click menu operation. • All functions are accessible by using the trackball alone. • Applicable to HSC (High Speed Craft) xi FOREWORD • TT, AIS, Radar Plotter and Interswitch supplied as standard. • Meets the requirements in IEC 62388 (Maritime navigation and radiocommunication equipment and systems - Shipborne radar - Performance requirements, methods of testing and required test results). • Meets the requirements in IMO MSC.192(79). • Meets the requirements in IEC 62288 (Maritime navigation and radiocommunication equipment and systems - Presentation of navigation-related information on shipborne navigational displays - General requirements, methods of testing and required test results). • Target alarm watches for targets entering or exiting an alarm zone • TCPA/CPA alarms • Electronic parallel index lines • 42 rpm antenna for high speed craft Usage Limitations The FAR-2xx7 series is designed to be used between 85°N and 85°S. Accordingly, features that function with latitude and longitude data (AIS, plotter, etc.) become inoperative when the ship is higher than 85°N or 85°S, with the exception of the cursor latitude and longitude display, which is available between 85°N to 90°N. Compliance with MED and R&TTE Directive This radar compiles with MED 96/98/EC and its amendment 2002/75/EC of September 2, 2002 and also complies with the R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC. In accordance with Article 6-3 of the above-mentioned R&TTE directive, FURUNO intends to put this radar on the market of the following countries in EU as well other markets: Austria, Belgium, Cyprus, Denmark, Estonia, Finland, France, Germany, Greece, Hungary, Ireland, Italy, Latvia, Lithuania, Malta, Poland, Portugal, Slovenia, Spain, Sweden, The Netherlands, United Kingdom, Iceland, Norway. xii FOREWORD Radar Type and Function Availability This radar series is available in five specification types to meet the requirements of Authorities, and function availability depends on specification type. The table below shows those functions that have limited availability. This manual provides descriptions for all functions in this radar series, and we have endeavored to denote in the text those functions that have limited availability. For detailed information on function availability, see the menu tree in the Appendix. • • • • • IMO: IMO compliant A: Near-IMO specifications B: Non-Japanese fishing vessels C: Japanese fishing vessels W: Washington state (USA) ferry Specification type and function availability Function TT symbol selection TT w/o gyro Acquisition zone range limitation Auto target track Chart display Color echo Cursor range unit selection Cursor size Dual radar Echo area configuration Mark color Mark w/line Pop-up guidance Range IMO Type No No Yes Yes Yes No Yes No No Yes No Yes No Yes No No Yes Yes Yes Yes No No No Yes No No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No No No No No Yes No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes No No No No No No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 0.75, 1.5, 3, 6, 12, 24, 48, 96 Same as IMO Same as B Same as B Range unit nm only nm only Sub display VRM unit Track-Other ship No No No No No Yes 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 0.75, 1, 1.5, 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 12, 16, 24, 32, 48, 96, 120 nm, sm, km, kyd Yes Yes Yes nm, sm, km, kyd Yes Yes Yes nm, sm, km, kyd Yes No Yes xiii FOREWORD Specification type and function availability (con't) Function Trail Eraser Trails-Color Trails-Hide Trails-Long Trails-Narrow WPT marker IMO No No No No No No Type No No No No No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Yes(12H/24H) Yes Yes Signal Processing Functions This radar has the signal processing functions described in the table below. All signal processing functions are set with the Picture feature. See section 1.35 for additional information. Signal processing function Description Interference rejector Suppress interference transmitted by other radars. Interference received simultaneously from many radars can be difficult to reduce. Echo stretch Enlarge target echoes, especially small echoes. Suppress interference, sea clutter and rain clutter before using echo stretch, to prevent the enlargement of unwanted echoes. Echo averaging The radar samples echoes with each scan. Targets that show a large change with each scan are judged as clutter and are reduced to display only echoes from legitimate targets. Requires position and speed data. Noise rejector Suppress white noise and increase the S/N ratio to improve picture clarity. Wiper Suppress unwanted echoes that appear after the sweep completes a scan (within one second). xiv Section 1.25 1.26 1.27 1.28 1.29 PROGRAM NUMBER PC Board Program No. Version No. MAIN 035-9204 03.** (Merchant) RFC 035-9202 01.** KEY(REMOTE) 035-9203 01.** ARPA 035-9212 01.** ** Minor modification xv SYSTEM CONFIGURATION See page xvii for detailed information about antenna units and radiators. With FURUNO-supplied monitor FAR-2137S/2837S/2837SW FAR-2117/2127/2817/2827/2827W ANTENNA UNIT (Performance Monitor PM-31* built in) ANTENNA UNIT (Performance Monitor PM-51* built in) Waveguide (For FAR-2827W) Waveguide or Coax cable (For FAR-2837SW) TRANSCEIVER UNIT RTR-081A For FAR-2827W TRANSCEIVER UNIT RTR-082 For FAR-2837SW MONITOR UNIT MU-190/201CR (FAR-21x7) or MU-231/231CR (FAR-28x7) CONTROL UNIT RCU-014 (Keyboard) or RCU-015 (Trackball) POWER SUPPLY UNIT PSU-007 (For FAR-2137S/2837S) OR POWER SUPPLY UNIT PSU-011* (For FAR-2827W/2837SW) * Russian flag only Control Unit RCU-016 (Remote) PROCESSOR UNIT RPU-013 24 VDC RU-3423 115/230 VAC 24 VDC or 115/230 VAC Sub Display Alarm VDR External Monitor : Standard IEC-61162-1 Serial Data Navigator (INS, GPS, etc.) (Input/Output) IEC-61162-1 Serial Data Speed Log (Input) : Option Gyrocompass : Dockyard supply AD-100 Category of Units Antenna unit: Exposed to weather All other units: Protected from weather 100-230 VAC AIS Track Control Unit Memory Card Interface Unit CU-200 OR Memory Card Interface Unit CU-200 x 2 Switching Hub HUB-100 HUB has ports for connection of up to 7 processor units AC spec DC spec Rectifier RU-3424 RU-1746B-2 xvi Transformer Unit RU-1803 * These monitors have been approved by the IMO, MU-190/201CR for CAT2, MU-231/231CR for CAT1. If a different monitor is to be used, its effective diameter must meet the applicable Category requirements: CAT 1: effective diameter 320 mm or higher CAT 2: effective diameter 250 mm or higher For installation and operation of other monitor, see its manuals. SYSTEM CONFIGURATION Antenna unit FAR-2117, FAR-2117-BB, FAR-2127, FAR-2127-BB, FAR-2827 RSB-096 (24 rpm) RSB-097 (42 rpm) FAR-2137S, FAR-2137S-BB RSB-098/099 (21/26 rpm, 200 VAC, 3ø, 50 Hz; 220 VAC, 3ø, 60 Hz; 380 VAC, 3ø, 50 Hz, 440 VAC, 3ø, 60 Hz) RSB-100/101/102 (45 rpm, 220 VAC, 3ø, 50/60 Hz(HSC); 440 VAC, 3ø, /60 Hz(HSC)) FAR-2827W RSB-103 (24 rpm, powered by processor unit) FAR-2837S Same as FAR-2137S FAR-2837SW RSB-104/105 (21/26 rpm, 200 VAC, 3ø, 50 Hz; 220 VAC, 3ø, 60 Hz; 380 VAC, 3ø, 50 Hz, 440 VAC, 3ø, 60 Hz) Radiator FAR-2117, FAR-2117-BB, FAR-2127, FAR-2127-BB, FAR-2827 XN12AF (4 ft), XN20AF (6.5 ft), XN24AF (8 ft) FAR-2137S, FAR-2137S-BB SN30AF (10 ft), SN36AF (12 ft) FAR-2827W XN20AF (6.5 ft), XN24AF (8 ft) FAR-2837S SN30AF (10 ft), SN36AF (12 ft) FAR-2837SW SN30AF (10 ft), SN36AF (12 ft) xvii SYSTEM CONFIGURATION Blackbox type FAR-2137S-BB FAR-2117-BB/2127-BB ANTENNA UNIT (Performance Monitor PM-51 built in FAR-2137S-BB) ANTENNA UNIT (Performance Monitor PM-31 built in FAR-2117-BB, FAR-2127-BB) VGA Monitor CONTROL UNIT RCU-014 (Keyboard) or RCU-015 (Trackball) POWER SUPPLY UNIT PSU-007 (For FAR-2137S-BB/2837S-BB) Control Unit RCU-016 (Remote) PROCESSOR UNIT RPU-013 Sub Display Alarm VDR External Monitor : Standard IEC-61162-1 Serial Data Navigator (INS, GPS, etc.) (Input/Output) IEC-61162-1 Serial Data Speed Log (Input) : Option Gyrocompass : Dockyard supply AD-100 Category of Units Antenna unit: Exposed to weather All other units: Protected from weather 100-230 VAC AIS Track Control Unit Memory Card Interface Unit CU-200 OR Memory Card Interface Unit CU-200 x 2 Switching Hub HUB-100 HUB has ports for connection of up to 7 processor units AC spec DC spec Rectifier RU-3424 RU-1746B-2 xviii Transformer Unit RU-1803 SYSTEM CONFIGURATION Console type RCN-001/RCN-002 FAR-2137S/2837S/2837SW FAR-2117/2127/2817/2827/2827W ANTENNA UNIT (Performance Monitor PM-51 built in) ANTENNA UNIT (Performance Monitor PM-31 built in) Waveguide (For FAR-2827W) Waveguide or Coax cable (For FAR-2837SW) TRANSCEIVER UNIT RTR-081A For FAR-2827W TRANSCEIVER UNIT RTR-082 For FAR-2837SW CONSOLE RCN-001/002 Alarm VDR POWER SUPPLY UNIT PSU-007 For FAR-2137S/2837S OR POWER SUPPLY UNIT PSU-011* (For FAR-2827W/2837SW) External Monitor IEC-61162-1 Serial Data (Input/Output) * Russian flag only Navigator (INS, GPS, etc.) IEC-61162-1 Serial Data Speed Log (Input) Gyrocompass PROCESSOR UNIT RPU-013 AD-100 AIS : Standard OR : Option : Dockyard supply Category of Units Antenna unit: Exposed to weather All other units: Protected from weather May also be installed externally. Memory Card Interface Unit CU-200 Track Control Unit 100-230 VAC Switching Hub HUB-100 Memory Card Interface Unit CU-200 (Max. 2 total) AC spec Transformer Unit RU-1803 100-115 VAC/ 220-230 VAC 1φ, 50/60 Hz 440 VAC 1φ, 50/60 Hz xix SYSTEM CONFIGURATION Console type RCN-003/RCN-004 FAR-2117/2127/2817/2827/2827W FAR-2137S/2837S/2837SW ANTENNA UNIT (Performance Monitor PM-51 built in) ANTENNA UNIT (Performance Monitor PM-31 built in) Waveguide (For FAR-2827W) Waveguide or Coax cable (For FAR-2837SW) TRANSCEIVER UNIT RTR-081A For FAR-2827W TRANSCEIVER UNIT RTR-082 For FAR-2837SW CONSOLE RCN-003/004 POWER SUPPLY UNIT PSU-007 For FAR-2137S/2837S OR POWER SUPPLY UNIT PSU-011* (For FAR-2827W/2837SW) * Russian flag only Alarm VDR External Monitor IEC-61162-1 Serial Data (Input/Output) Navigator (INS, GPS, etc.) IEC-61162-1 Serial Data Speed Log (Input) Gyrocompass PROCESSOR UNIT RPU-013 AD-100 AIS : Standard : Option Switching Hub HUB-100 Track Control Unit : Dockyard supply Category of Units Antenna unit: Exposed to weather All other units: Protected from weather Memory Card Interface Unit CU-200 Memory Card Interface Unit CU-200 (Max. 2 total) AC spec Transformer Unit RU-1803 100-115 VAC/ 220-230 VAC 1φ, 50/60 Hz xx 440 VAC 1φ, 50/60 Hz 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.1 Turning on the Power The [POWER] switch ( ) is located at the left corner of the control unit. Open the POWER switch cover and press the switch to turn on the radar system. To turn off the radar, press the switch again. The screen shows the bearing scale and digital timer approximately 30 seconds after power-on. The timer counts down three minutes of warm-up time. During this period the magnetron (transmitter tube) is warmed for transmission. When the timer has reached 0:00, the indication "ST-BY" appears at the screen center, meaning the radar is now ready to transmit pulses. In the stand-by condition, markers, rings, map, charts, etc. are not shown. Further, TT and AIS are not shown. In the warm-up and stand-by conditions, ON TIME and TX TIME count in hours and tenths of hour appear at the screen center. Note 1: Do not turn the power on directly after it has been turned off. Wait several seconds before you reapply the power, to be sure the radar starts up properly. Note 2: Parameters set on the menus are stored in a non-volatile memory (flash memory), and are preserved when the power is turned off. 1.2 Transmitter ON After the power is turned on and the magnetron has warmed up, ST-BY appears at the screen center, meaning the radar is ready to transmit radar pulses. You may transmit by pressing the [STBY/TX] key on the full keyboard, or use the trackball to select the TX STBY box at the bottom left corner of the display then push the left button (above the trackball). The label at the left-hand side of the guidance box at the bottom right corner of the screen changes from TX to STBY. TX STBY STBY Guidance box TX STBY box Radar display 1-1 1. RADAR OPERATION The radar is initially set to previously used range and pulse length. Other settings such as brilliance levels, VRMs, EBLs and menu option selections are also set to previous settings. The [STBY/TX] key (or TX STBY box) toggles the radar between STBY and TRANSMIT status. The antenna stops in stand-by and rotates in transmit. The magnetron ages with time resulting in a reduction of output power. Therefore, it is highly recommended that the radar be set to stand-by when not used for an extended period of time. How to stop antenna rotation Antenna rotation can be stopped. One method is to turn off the antenna switch on the radar. The other method is to stop rotation from the menu. For how to stop rotation from the menu, see the installation manual. Picture freeze When the picture freezes the picture is not updated. 30 seconds after the picture freezes, the buzzer sounds, the [ALARM ACK] key blinks and the alarm contact signal is output. Reset the power to restore normal operation. Quick start Provided that the radar was once in use with the transmitter tube (magnetron) still warm, you can turn the radar into TRANSMIT condition without three minutes of warm-up. If the [POWER] switch was turned off by mistake or the like and you wish to restart the radar promptly, turn on the [POWER] switch not later than 10 seconds after power-off. Echo area The echo display area for the B, C and W types is available in three configurations: round, wide, and full screen. You can select a configuration with 7 ECHO AREA on the ECHO menu. Round 1-2 Wide Full 1. RADAR OPERATION Control Unit Two types of control units are available: Control Unit RCU-014 (full keyboard) and Control Unit RCU-105 (palm control). EBL rotary control VRM rotary control Scrollwheel Left button A/C RAIN BRILL OFF A/C SEA ON OFF EBL Right button GAIN ON HL OFF EBL OFFSET MODE F1 F2 OFF CENTER CU/TM RESET INDEX LINE F3 F4 VECTOR TIME VECTOR MODE TARGET LIST ALARM ACK STBY TX CANCEL TRAILS VRM MENU ACQ TARGET DATA RANGE BRILL ENTER MARK 1.3 TARGET CANCEL Trackball Trackball Module Control Unit RCU-014 (full keyboard) Scrollwheel Left button Right button F1 Trackball F2 F3 F4 Trackball Module Control Unit RCU-015 (palm control) 1-3 1. RADAR OPERATION Control description Control Description Control Unit RCU-014 (full keyboard) POWER Turns the system on and off. EBL and VRM rotary controls Adjust EBL and VRM, respectively. EBL ON, EBL OFF Turns the EBLs on and off, respectively. F1-F4 Execute menu short cut assigned. ALARM ACK Silences audio alarm. STBY TX Toggles between stand-by and transmit. BRILL Adjusts display brilliance. A/C RAIN Suppresses rain clutter. A/C SEA Suppresses sea clutter. GAIN Adjusts sensitivity of the radar receiver. HL OFF Temporarily erases the heading line while pressed. EBL OFFSET Enables, disables the offset EBL. In menu operation, switches polarity from North to South and East to West and vice versa. MODE Selects a presentation mode. OFF CENTER Shifts own ship position. CU/TM RESET • Moves own ship position in 75% radius in stern direction. • Resets the heading line to 0° in course-up and true motion modes. INDEX LINE Turns parallel index (PI) lines on and off. VECTOR TIME Selects vector time (length). VECTOR MODE Selects vector mode, relative or true. TARGET LIST Displays data for all tracked targets (AIS and TT). CANCEL TRAILS Cancels all target trails. In menu operation it clears a line of data. ENTER MARK Enters marks; terminates keyboard input. VRM ON, VRM OFF Turns the VRMs on and off, respectively. MENU Opens and closes the MAIN menu; closes other menus. ACQ Acquires a target for TT after choosing it with the trackball. RANGE TARGET DATA Selects radar range. Display or erase target data for TT or AIS target chosen with trackball. For AIS, changes sleeping target to activated target. TARGET CANCEL TT: Cancel tracking on target. AIS: Sleep an activated target. Control Unit RCU-015 (palm control) POWER Turns the system on and off. F1-F4 Execute menu short cut assigned. 1-4 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.4 Main Menu You may access the MAIN menu from the full keyboard or by using the trackball. In later sections only the procedure for menu operation by trackball is given. Main menu operation by keyboard 1. Press the [MENU] key. The MAIN menu appears in the text area at the right side of the screen. [MAIN MENU] [ECHO] [MARK] [ALARM] [TT AIS] [PLOTTER] [CARD] [NAV DATA] [NAV LINE WPT] [CUSTOMIZE TEST] Echo processing functions Mainly turns markers on/off. Sets guard alarm functions; outputs alarm signal. Sets TT and AIS functions. Chart and track functions Memory card functions Turns nav data on/off. Processes nav lines and waypoints. Customizes operation; executes diagnostics. MAIN menu 2. Press the numeral key corresponding to the menu you wish to open. For example, press the [2] key to open the MARK menu. [MARK] 1 BACK 2 OWN SHIP MARK OFF/MIN/SCALED 3 STERN MARK OFF/ON 4 [PI LINE] 5 ANCHOR WATCH OFF/ON 0.0NM 6 DROP MARK OFF/ON 7 [INS MARK] *1 8 EBL OFFSET BASE STAB GND/STAB HDG/ STAB NORTH 9 [EBL, VRM, CURSOR SET]*2 *1 [BARGE MARK] depending on installation preset. 0 RING *2 IMO and A types show OFF/ON 9 EBL CURSOR BEARING (REL/TRUE) MARK menu 3. Press the numeral key applicable to the item you wish to set. 4. Consecutively press the same numeral key pressed at step 3 to select appropriate option then press the [ENTER MARK] key to confirm your selection. 5. Press the [MENU] key to close the menu. Useful keys in menu operation To clear a line of numeric data: Use the [CANCEL TRAILS] key. Switch between plus and minus, North and South or East and West: Use the [2] key. 1-5 1. RADAR OPERATION Main menu operation by trackball 1. Use the trackball to select the MENU box at the right side of the screen. The guidance box at the bottom right corner (see the illustration at the bottom of the next page for location) now reads "DISP MAIN MENU." 2. Push the left button to display the MAIN menu. [MAIN MENU] [ECHO] [MARK] [ALARM] [TT AIS] [PLOTTER] [CARD] [NAV DATA] [NAV LINE WPT] [CUSTOMIZE TEST] Echo processing functions Mainly turns markers on/off. Sets guard alarm functions; outputs alarm signal. Sets TT and AIS functions. Chart and track functions Memory card functions Turns nav data on/off. Processes nav lines and waypoints. Customizes operation; executes diagnostics. MAIN menu 3. Roll the scrollwheel or trackball to select a menu and push the left button. For example, select the 2 [MARK] menu. [MARK] 1 BACK 2 OWN SHIP MARK OFF/MIN/SCALED 3 STERN MARK OFF/ON 4 [PI LINE] 5 ANCHOR WATCH OFF/ON 0.0NM 6 DROP MARK OFF/ON 7 [INS MARK] *1 8 EBL OFFSET BASE STAB GND/STAB HDG/ STAB NORTH 9 [EBL, VRM, CURSOR SET]*2 *1 [BARGE MARK] depending on installation preset. 0 RING *2 IMO and A types show OFF/ON 9 EBL CURSOR BEARING (REL/TRUE) MARK menu 4. Use the trackball to select a menu item and push the left button. 5. Roll the scrollwheel to select an option and push the left button to validate your selection. 6. Push the right button consecutively to close the menu. (Several pushes may be necessary depending on the menu used.) Note: Hereafter all menu procedures are described using the trackball module (trackball, scrollwheel, buttons). For sake of brevity we write, "Select [menu item] (or [menu option])" where you roll the scrollwheel and push the left button (or scrollwheel) to complete a task on the menu. 1-6 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.5 Operation by the On-Screen Boxes All radar functions can be accessed by using the trackball alone. This is done by choosing the appropriate on-screen box with the trackball and operating the trackball module to select item and option. (See section 1.9 for location of all on-screen boxes.) On-screen boxes come in two varieties: Function selection and function selection w/pop-up menu. On-screen boxes of the latter type have "►" at the right side of their boxes, as in the MARK box shown below. To operate the radar using on-screen boxes, do the following: 1. Use the trackball to place the trackball marker inside the box desired. Note: The trackball marker changes its configuration according to its location. It is an arrow when placed outside the effective display and a cursor (+) when inside the effective display. See the illustration on the next page for further details. For example, select the MARK box, which is at the bottom left corner. MARK Mark type last selected, mark number -> + 162.5°T 11.7 NM Bearing and range from own ship to mark MARK box When a box is correctly selected, its color changes from green to orange and the guidance box at the bottom right corner shows operational guidance. The operational guidance shows the function of the left and right buttons, with a diagonal line separating the information. For the MARK box, for example, the operational guidance is "MARK SELECT / MARK MENU." In this case you would push the left button to select a mark or push the right button to open the MARK menu. Function of left button Function of right button MARK MARK Box >+ MARK MARK SELECT MENU Guidance box Arrow For choosing on-screen box Guidance box (Example: guidance for MARK box) 1-7 1. RADAR OPERATION Trackball marker location and guidance box indication The trackball marker is either a cursor (+) or an arrow ( ) depending on whether it is within or outside the display area, respectively. Further, the indication in the guidance box changes according to trackball marker location. Guidance box reads "JUMP CURSOR / DISP MENU." Push the left button to choose the on-screen box closest to the arrow or push the right button to display the MAIN menu. Trackball marker is out of effective display area (incl. text area) and not selecting a box: The trackball marker is an arrow To choose boxes successively, push the wheel when the guidance box reads as above. Then, the nearest box is selected and marked with the double-ended arrow ( ) and the guidance box reads "JUMP FORWARD / JUMP BACKWARD." Hit the left button to go to the box below or adjacent to the currently selected box or hit the right button to go to the box above or adjacent to the currently selected box. Continue pushing a button to choose boxes successively. This is convenient for operation under heavy pitching and rolling. To cancel this feature, push the wheel when the guidance box reads as above. Guidance box reads "TARGET DATA & ACQ / CURSOR MENU." In this condition you may access cursor-operated functions, by hitting the left button for direct selection of function or the right button to choose desired functions from the CURSOR menu. For further details about the CURSOR menu, see section 1.6. Trackball marker is within effective display area: The trackball marker is a cursor. 2. Push the left button (or roll the scrollwheel depending on the box) until the desired option is displayed in the box. Note: When you selected an on-screen box’s option by rolling the scrollwheel, the box and its contents turn light-blue. This simply indicates that the selected setting is different from the currently active setting. To change the setting, push the scrollwheel or the left button. If neither the scrollwheel nor the left button is pushed within about 30 seconds after operating the scrollwheel, the previous setting is automatically restored. 1-8 1. RADAR OPERATION 3. The pop-up menu attached to the MARK box is the MARK menu. To open the menu, push the right button. The menu opens in the text area at the right side of the screen. [MARK MENU] 1 ORIGIN MARK STAB GND/SEA 2 MARK KIND ORIGIN MARK(No. )/ ORIGIN MARK(SYM)/ MAP MARK/ WP 1~50/ WP 51~ 100/ WP 101~150/ WP 151~198/ OWN SHIP SHAPE 8 MARK POSN CURSOR/OS/L/L 00°000.00 N 000°000.00 E 9 MAP DISPLAY OFF/ON 0 MAP MARK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT * Not available on IMO or A type MARK menu Note:Any menu may be operated from the full keyboard or with the trackball, or a combination of the two in case of Control Unit RCU-014. Note that in later sections only the procedure for menu operation by the trackball is given. 4. Select item desired. Selected item is initially shown in reverse video and changes to normal video and circumscribed when the scrollwheel or the left button is pushed. 5. Select option desired. Selected option is initially shown in reverse video and changes to normal video and circumscribed when the scrollwheel or the left button is pushed. 6. Push the right button to close the menu. (On some menus several presses of the right button are required to close the menu.) 1-9 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.6 Cursor Menu Functions that require the use of the cursor, such as EBL offset and zoom, may be activated directly from the guidance box or from the CURSOR menu, either method with the cursor inside the effective display area. Below is the procedure for choosing a cursor-related function from the CURSOR menu. In later sections only the procedure for selection from the guidance box is given. 1. Put the cursor inside the effective display area. 2. Roll the scrollwheel to show "TARGET DATA & ACQ / CURSOR MENU" in the guidance box. 3. Push the right button to show the CURSOR menu. 4. Select "2" then push the left button. 5. Select function desired then push the left button. [CURSOR MENU] TARGET DATA & ACQ/ TARGET CANCEL/ TT TGT DATA & ACQ/ TARGET TRACK ON*1/ TARGET TRACK OFF*1/ REF MARK/ EBL OFFSET/ OFFCENTER/ ZOOM/ MARK DELETE/ OWN TRACK DELETE/ TGT TRACK DELETE*1/ CHART ALIGN TRAIL ERASER*1, *2/ 9 CURSOR*1, *2 SMALL/LARGE *1 Not available on IMO type *1 Not available on A type Note: For operation from the keyboard, you may press the [2] key to select a function in top-to-bottom order or the [8] key to select in reverse order. Cursor Menu item TARGET DATA & ACQ TARGET CANCEL TT TARGET DATA & ACQ TARGET TRACK ON TARGET TRACK OFF REF MARK EBL OFFSET OFF CENTER ZOOM MARK DELETE OWN TRACK DELETE TGT TRACK DELETE CHART ALIGN TRAIL ERASER CURSOR SIZE Description TT: Acquires target; displays data for selected tracked target. AIS: Activates sleeping AIS target; display data for selected AIS target. TT: Cancels tracking on selected tracked target. AIS: Sleeps selected AIS target. Acquires selected echo as tracked target. Turns track for TT/AIS on. Turns track for TT/AIS off. Inscribes reference mark, for target-based speed input. Offsets EBL to measure range and bearing between two targets. Shifts screen center to selected location. Zooms selected location. Deletes selected mark (plotter mark, origin mark or waypoint mark). Deletes own ship’s tracks. Deletes other ship’s tracks. Aligns chart with radar picture. Erases trails. (A, B and C types) Selects cursor size. (A, B and C types) 6. The guidance box shows "XX / EXIT." (XX = function selected). Use the trackball to put the cursor where desired. 7. Push the left button to execute the function selected at step 5. 8. To quit the function selected, push the right button when the guidance box shows "XX / EXIT." (XX = function selected at step 5) 1-10 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.7 Monitor Brilliance The brilliance of the entire screen should be adjusted according to lighting conditions. Monitor brilliance should be adjusted before adjusting relative brilliance levels on the BRILL menu to be explained later. Note: The brilliance of a commercial monitor cannot be adjusted from the radar. See the owner’s manual of the commercial monitor for how to adjust its brilliance. By keyboard Operate the [BRILL] control on the control unit to adjust brilliance. Turn it clockwise to increase brilliance; counterclockwise to decrease brilliance. Watch the BRILL box (see illustration below) to know current brilliance level. By trackball 1. Use the trackball to place the arrow on the brilliance level indicator in the brilliance level indication box at the bottom left corner of the screen. Brilliance bar Shows brilliance level. Place arrow inside box to adjust screen brilliance. BRILL1 26 Brilliance level Brillance, color set no. (For details, see para. 1.50.) Brilliance level indicator 2. Roll the scrollwheel downward to increase brilliance or roll it upward to decrease brilliance. The length of the brilliance bar increases or decreases with operation of the scrollwheel. Note: If nothing appears on the screen in stand-by when using Control Unit RCU-015 (palm control), press and hold down one of the keys F1-F4* to raise the brilliance to level "50". *Key set for other than USER DEFAULT. See section 1.36.2. 1-11 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.8 Display Modes This radar has the following display modes: • IMO, A type: Radar, Radar + Plotter, Anchor (Watch) • B, C, W type: Radar, Radar + Plotter, Plotter Select a display mode as below. Note that a display mode cannot be selected when the menu is open. 1. Use the trackball to place the arrow in the DISPLAY MODE box at the top of the screen. DISPLAY XX* * XX = display mode DISPLAY MODE box 2. Push the left button to select appropriate mode. Radar: Radar display +Plotter Radar display, plotter display Plotter: Plotter display Anchor watch: Plotter display Note: The radar echo related boxes (STBY/TX, PI line, target alarm, etc.) are inoperative in the anchor watch and plotter modes. 1-12 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.9 On-Screen Boxes and Markers Trial Maneuver (Elapsed time shown when trial maneuver is active.) Range, Bearing and TTG to cursor position Cursor Position Box PICTURE Box, Main Picture Settings PULSELENGTH Box ANTENNA Box PRESENTATION MODE Box RANGE Box REF POINT Setting DISPLAY MODE Box NM /1 HEAD UP TB RM DISPLAY RADAR REF POINT ANT 340 ANT 1 X-BAND PULSE S1 SET and DRIFT Boxes GAIN Setting A/C SEA Setting A/C RAIN Setting TUNING Setting SET 000. 0°T DRIFT 0. 0kn 350 000 010 020 330 PICTURE4 040 Heading Line 310 300 AIS Base Station PI Line 290 050 AtoN PI 1 ON 032. 0°T 5. 60NM MARK MAP 060 ZOOM or TT DATA BOX 070 Range (See next page.) No. 1 VRM 190.0°T, 5.75NM 26 BRILL1 HL EBL1 OFF TX EBL2 STBY Stern Marker North Marker 130 210 WATCH 11 : 28 TT < AIS DISP TARGET OFF FILT LIST 30M VECTOR REL AZ1 PAST POSN REL 3M AZ2 CPA LIMIT 0. 5NM 22MIN ALARM1 CPA AUTO ACTIVATE OFF ALARM2 LOST TARGET ALARM OFF TRUE-S TRAIL OFF ALERT BOX CU/TM 00:00 (See next page.) RESET VRM1 DROP2 ALARM TARGET CURSOR VRM2 ACK DATA & ACQ MENU TT ACQ MODE Box ASSOCIATION ON/OFF AIS DISP Box AIS Message Arrvl 150 200 190 DROP1 229.8°T 4.532NM EBL2 Box EBL1 Box CHART ALIGN 140 220 >280.9°T< 240. 8°T TARGET LIST Box WATCH Box Chart Align ON TT, AIS DATA BOX 110 No. 2 VRM 120 230 or AIS DATA BOX (See next page.) 100 Own Ship Marker Drop Mark No. 2 EBL ON ORIGIN* Heading Speed, Source Log Speed Course over Ground Speed over Ground, Source Position MENU Box MENU 090 240 BT COG SOG Cursor 260 250 000.0°T 0.0kn LOG SB 0.0kn 34°40. 649 N 00.0°T 135°18. 303 E GPS TTG 312.3°R 0.0kn 00:11 1.864NM OS POSN 34°40.00N DGPS TRIAL OFF 135°24.00E No. 1 EBL 270 HDG SPD 25 22 19 Rings ZOOM, TT, 080 Acquisition Zone 280 030 320 IR OFF ES OFF EAV OFF AUTO RAIN OFF GAIN SEA AUTO RAIN TUNE AUTO 180 170 Origin Mark Drop Mark data * W-type only. Denotes mark TX/STBY Box selection: HL OFF Box ORIGIN: Origin mark MAP: Map mark BRILL Box OS: Own ship shape MARK Box Bearing and range to mark PI line number PI line orientation PI line interval 160 >3.682NM< 5.221NM CU/TM RESET, ALARM ACK Box Guidance Box LOST TARGET Box CPA AUTO Box CPA LIMIT Box PAST POSN Box VRM2 Box VRM1 Box (w/TTG) TT VECTOR Box TRAIL MODE Box TARGET ALARM Box AZ (Acquisition Zone) Box Markers and indications Viewing distance The optimal viewing distances for the radar display units are as follows: - MU-170C: 920 mm - MU-201CR: 1080 mm - MU-231CR: 1200 mm - MU-190: 1020 mm - MU-231: 1200 mm Note: Magnetic fields do not affect the picture. 1-13 1. RADAR OPERATION HDG SPD SB COG SOG 9.9kn BT WT MAN 0.1kn 30.2°T 10.2.2kn GPS OS POSN Electronic Position-fixing System and position* Depth DGPS 34°40.00N 135°24.00E TRUE 15.4 m/s WIND 159.9°T DEPTH 22.30 m Depth Echogram (See section 1.41.) -30 20 10 Zoom display appears in nav data box when nav data is turned off. Heading is TRUE (variation-corrected gyro or magnetic heading) Speed data is LOG, MAN, etc., showing sensor and types. 242.2°T CURRENT TEMP WPT001 DATE 20 40 60 80 100 2.3kn 16°C 6.5NM OCT/25/03 69.9°R TTG 00:00:00 35.2°R 10:00 UTC TT Target Data (or Zoom) TT Target Data (See Chapter 3.) * GPS, DGPS, PPS, RTK, FRTK, DR. PPS, RTK and FRTK require GGA sentence. Wind Speed and Angle* (True or Relative angle) Tide relative to North, full scale 10 kn Wind direction relative to own ship heading Current speed and direction* Water temperature, TTG, WPT no., range and bearing to waypoint Date, time * Referenced to ship's heading (relative) in head-up, head-up TB and course-up. Referenced to North (true) in north-up and true motion. For presentation mode description, see section 1.12. TT TARGET No. 42 BRG 25.5°T RNG 3.4NM R COG 264.0°T R SOG 12.3KN CPA 2.9NM TCPA 12.2MIN BCR 1.7NM BCT 20MIN EPFS shall meet the requirements of the IMO resolution MSC.112(73). TT, AIS Functions Box - - - - - SYSTEM ERROR - - - - VIDEO - - - - - - - - - WARNING - - - - - - - FORMAT CARD DATA Guidance Box Data fields 1-14 Alert Box Messages for sensor error, system error, alarms and warning. See section 1.44 for details. 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.10 Tuning the Receiver 1.10.1 Choosing the tuning method The tuning method can be selected with the TUNE box at the top of the screen. 1. Select the TUNE box (TUNE AUTO or TUNE MAN) at the top of the screen. Tuning bar Place arrow inside box to adjust tuning, when TUNE MAN is selected. Tuning method (AUTO or MAN) TUNE AUTO Tuning level TUNE box 2. Push the left button or scrollwheel to display TUNE AUTO or TUNE MAN as appropriate. 3. If you used the scrollwheel to select tuning method, push the scrollwheel or the left button to change setting. 1.10.2 Initializing tuning Automatic tuning is initialized during the installation. However, if you feel that automatic tuning is not working properly try re-initializing it as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 1 [ECHO]. [ECHO] 1 BACK 2 2ND ECHO REJ OFF/ON 3 TUNE INITIALIZE 4 PM*1 OFF/ON 5 SART OFF/ON 6 WIPER OFF/1/2 7 ECHO AREA*2 CIRCLE/WIDE/ALL 8 [PICTURE SELECT] *1 Not available on FAR-2157/2167DS *2 Not available on IMO or A type 9 STC RANGE +00 ECHO menu 3. Select 3 TUNE INITIALIZE. (For operation from the keyboard, press the [ENTER MARK] key.) "WARNING – TUNE INITIALIZE" appears in the Alert Box during the initialization. 4. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 1-15 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.10.3 Automatic tuning Select automatic tuning following section 1.10.1. The TUNE box shows TUNE AUTO. 1.10.4 Manual tuning 1. Select the 48-mile range from the RANGE box. Push the left button to lower the range; the right button to raise the range. 2. Select manual tuning following the procedure in section 1.10.1. 3. Use the trackball to place the arrow on the tuning bar area in the TUNE box. 4. Roll the scrollwheel to adjust tuning. The best tuning point is where the bar graph swings maximum. The arrow below the bar graph shows tuning control position; not the tuning condition. 1.11 Aligning Heading with Gyrocompass With connection of a gyrocompass, ship's heading is displayed at the right side of the screen. Turn on the radar and match the on-screen GYRO readout with the gyrocompass reading as shown below. Once you have set the initial heading correctly, resetting is not usually required. This alignment is not necessary for the FURUNO SC-60/120 Satellite Compass. 1. Right-click the HDG box at the top right corner of the screen. [HDG MENU] 1 HDG SOURCE AD-10/SERIAL 2 GC-10 SETTING 000.0° HDG menu 2. Roll the scrollwheel downward to select GC-10 SETTING. Note: If the heading source selected is not suitable change it at 1 HDG SOURCE to match your heading source. 3. Roll the scrollwheel to set the heading. (For entry through the keyboard, use the numeric keys.) 4. Push the scrollwheel to finish. 5. Push the right button to close the menu. 1-16 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.12 Presentation Modes This radar has the following presentation modes: Relative Motion (RM) Head-up: Unstabilized Head-up TB: Head-up with compass-stabilized bearing scale (True Bearing) where the bearing scale rotates with the compass reading. Course-up: Compass-stabilized relative to ship’s orientation at the time of selecting course-up. North-up: Compass-stabilized with reference to north Stern-up: The radar image is rotated 180°. Graphics and relative and true bearings are also rotated 180°. True Motion (TM) Land objects and sea are stationary. Requires compass and speed data. 1.12.1 Choosing presentation mode By keyboard Press the [MODE] key consecutively to select presentation mode desired. The PRESENTATION MODE box shows the current presentation mode. (See the illustration below.) By trackball Left-click the PRESENTATION MODE box at the top left corner of the screen to select a presentation mode. HEAD UP RM* * = Other modes: STERN-UP, HEAD UP TB RM, COURSE UP RM, NORTH UP RM, NORTH UP TM PRESENTATION MODE box Loss of gyrocompass signal When the compass signal is lost, "GYRO" appears in red in the Alert Box, the presentation mode automatically becomes head-up, and TT and AIS targets, map and chart are erased. After restoring the compass signal, "HEADING SET" appears in the Alert Box. Then, stop the alarm with the [ALARM ACK] key or the ALARM ACK box and check the GYRO data. 1-17 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.12.2 Description of presentation modes Head-up mode The head-up mode is a display in which the line connecting own ship and the top of the display indicates own ship’s heading. The target pips are painted at their measured distances and in their directions relative to own ship’s heading. A short line on the bearing scale is the north marker indicating heading sensor north. A failure of the heading sensor input will cause the north marker to disappear and the readout to show ***.*° and the message HDG SIG MISSING appears in red at the lower-right corner of the screen. Heading Line North Marker Note: When display is off-centered, the heading mark appears at 000 degrees. Head-up mode Course-up mode The course-up mode is an azimuth-stabilized display in which a line connecting the center with the top of the display indicates own ship’s intended course (namely, own ship’s previous heading just before this mode has been selected). Target pips are painted at their measured distances and in their directions relative to the intended course, which is maintained at the 0-degree position. The heading line moves in accordance with ship’s yawing and course change. This mode is useful to avoid smearing of picture during course change. North Marker Heading Line Course-up mode 1-18 1. RADAR OPERATION Head-up TB (True Bearing) mode Radar echoes are shown in the same way as in the head-up mode. The difference from normal head-up presentation lies in the orientation of the bearing scale. The bearing scale is heading sensor stabilized. That is, it rotates in accordance with the heading sensor signal, enabling you to know own ship’s heading at a glance. This mode is available when the radar is interfaced with a gyrocompass. If the gyrocompass fails, the bearing scale returns to the state of head-up mode. North-up mode The north-up mode paints target pips at their measured distances and in their true (heading sensor) directions from own ship, north bearing maintained at the top of the screen. The heading line changes its direction according to the ship’s heading. Requires heading signal. If the compass fails, the presentation mode changes to head-up and the north marker disappears. Also, the HDG indication shows ***.*°. And the message HDG SIG MISSING appears in red at the lower-right corner of the screen. North Marker Heading Line North-up mode 1-19 1. RADAR OPERATION Stern-up mode The stern-up mode rotates the head-up mode picture, relative and true bearings and display graphics 180°. This mode is useful on dual-radar tugboats when backing up; one radar shows head-up and another shows stern-up. To enable the stern-up mode, turn on STERN-UP on the 7 OPERATION menu. North Marker Heading Line Stern-up mode 1-20 1. RADAR OPERATION True motion mode Own ship and other moving objects move in accordance with their true courses and speed. In ground stabilized TM, all fixed targets, such as landmasses, appear as stationary echoes. In the sea stabilized TM without set and drift inputs, the landmass can move on the screen. Note that true motion is not available on the 72 nm (non-IMO type only) or 96 nm range scale. If COG and SOG (both over the ground) are not available on TM mode, enter the set (tide direction) and drift (tide speed) manually referring to the Tide Table. When own ship reaches a point corresponding to 50% of the radius of the display, own ship position is automatically reset to a point of 75% radius opposite to the extension of the heading line passing through the display center. You may also reset the own ship symbol manually by pressing the [CU/TM RESET] key, or left-clicking the CU/TM RESET box at the bottom right corner of the display. If the heading sensor fails, the mode is changed to the head-up and the north marker disappears. The HDG readout shows ***.*° and the message HDG SIG MISSING appears in red at the lower-right corner of the screen. Note: A part of the bearing scale is drawn differently depending on antenna reference position. ANT: Bearing scale interval is different when display is offcentered. CONN: A part of the bearing scale is not displayed if the conning position is not within the radar display area. North Marker Heading Line True motion mode Automatic resetting of own ship mark in true motion mode Heading line North marker (a) True motion is selected (b) Own ship has reached a point 75% of display radius (c) Own ship is automatically reset to 75% of radius 1-21 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.13 Entering Own Ship's Speed The TT and azimuth stabilized presentation modes require own ship speed input and compass signal. The speed can be entered from a log (STW) or GPS (SOG) or manually on the menu. Note that FURUNO GPS Navigator GP-90 provides COG and SOG. 1.13.1 Automatic speed input by log or GPS navigator 1. Right-click the SPD box at the top right corner of the screen. [SPEED MENU] 1 SHIP SPEED LOG(BT)/LOG(WT)/ GPS/MANUAL/REF 2 MANUAL SPEED 0.0kn 3 SET DRIFT OFF/ON SPEED menu 2. Select 1 SHIP SPEED. 3. Select the appropriate source for automatic speed input then push the left button. LOG (BT): Log, speed over ground (SOG). Note that a log cannot produce BT (Bottom Tracking) speed in deep waters without set and drift entry. LOG (WT): Log, speed thru water (STW) GPS: Speed input by GPS navigator MANUAL: Manually input speed REF: Echo-referenced speed input 4. Push the right button to close the menu. Notes on speed input • IMO Resolution A.823(19) for TT recommends that a speed log to be interfaced with a TT should be capable of providing through-the-water speed (forward speed). • Be sure not to select a LOG option when a speed log is not connected. If the log signal is not provided, the ship speed readout at the top of the screen will be blank. In the event of a log error, enter speed manually. • The SPD is shown as "*.* kn" and the label "LOG" (in red) appears and the alarm buzzer sounds if no log signal is present for 30 s. • With the serial speed inputs and SOG selection, if the type of data is changed from SOG to STW the label "LOG" (in red) appears and the alarm buzzer sounds. 1-22 1. RADAR OPERATION • On the IMO type with AIS in use, LOG(WT), MANUAL and REF are shown in gray to indicate they are not available for selection. • A single-axis water log cannot measure speed when the wind is coming from the leeway direction. • If speed over the ground cannot be obtained in a deep area, select LOG(WT), turn on SET DRIFT and enter set and drift values. See section 3.12 for the procedure. 1.13.2 Manual speed input If the speed log is not working, enter speed manually as below. In this case the speed data type is shown as MANUAL and is speed thru water (STW). Manual speed input is not available on the IMO radar when the AIS feature is active. 1. Right-click the SPD box at the top right corner of the screen to display the SPEED menu. 2. Select 1 SHIP SPEED. 3. Select MANUAL then push the left button. 4. Select 2 MANUAL SPEED. 5. Roll the scrollwheel to set speed. (For entry through the keyboard, use the numeric keys.) 6. Push the left button to confirm setting. 7. Push the right button to close the menu. 1.14 Choosing a Range Scale The selected range scale, range ring interval and pulselength are shown at the upper left corner on the screen. When a target of interest comes closer, reduce the range scale so that it appears in 50-90% of the display radius. By keyboard Use the [RANGE] key to select range desired. Hit the "+" part of the key to raise the range; the "-" part to lower the range. By trackball 1. Use the trackball to select the RANGE box at the top left corner of the screen. The guidance box shows "RANGE DOWN / RANGE UP." 0.125 NM0.025 RANGE box 2. Push the left button to lower the range; the right button to raise the range. You may also select the range by rolling the scrollwheel then pushing it or the left button. 1-23 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.15 Choosing a Pulselength The pulselength in use is displayed at the upper-left position of the screen using the indications shown in the table below. Label and pulselength X-band 10, 25 kW, S-band 30 kW Indication Pulselength (μs) S1 (Short pulse 1) 0.07 S2 (Short pulse 2) 0.15 M1 (Medium pulse 1) 0.3 M2 (Medium pulse 2) 0.5 M3 (Medium pulse 3) 0.7 L (Long pulse) 1.2 Appropriate pulselengths are preset to individual range scales and function keys. If you are not satisfied with the current pulselength settings, you may change them as shown below. 1.15.1 Choosing a pulselength You can select the pulselength for the 0.5 to 24 nm range scales as below. 1. Right-click the PICTURE box at the left side of the screen to show the PICTURE menu. Note: The PICTURE box sets up the radar picture according to expected usage, such as harbor navigation, long range, short range, etc. For further details see section 1.35. [PICTURE MENU] 1 INT REJECT OFF/1/2/3 2 ECHO STRETCH OFF/1/2/3 3 ECHO AVERAGE OFF/1/2/3 4 NOISE REJ OFF/ON 5 AUTO STC OFF/ON 6 AUTO RAIN OFF/1/2/3/4 7 VIDEO CONTRAST 1/2/3/4/ A/B/C 8 [PULSE] 9 [CONDITION] 0 DEFAULT NO/SAVE/USER/ FACTORY 1-24 PICTURE menu 1. RADAR OPERATION 2. Select 8 [PULSE]. [PULSE MENU] 1 BACK 2 0.5NM S1/S2 3 0.75NM S1/S2/M1 4 1.5NM S1/S2/M1 5 3NM S2/M1/M2/M3 6 6NM M1/M2/M3/L 7 12-24NM M2/M3/L PULSE menu 3. Select a range then push the left button. 4. Select pulselength desired then push the left button. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 1.15.2 Changing pulselength 1. Use the trackball to select the PULSELENGTH box at the left side of the screen. The guidance box shows "PULSE SHORTER / PULSE LONGER." PULSE XX* * XX = Pulse width setting PULSELENGTH box 2. Push the left button to shorten the pulselength or the right button to lengthen the pulselength. You may also select the pulselength by rolling the scrollwheel and pushing it or the left button. 1-25 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.16 Adjusting the Sensitivity The gain control adjusts the sensitivity of the receiver. The proper setting is such that the background noise is just visible on the screen. If you set up for too little sensitivity, weak echoes may be missed. On the other hand excessive sensitivity yields too much background noise; strong targets may be missed because of the poor contrast between desired echoes and the background noise on the display. To adjust receiver sensitivity, adjust the gain control so background noise is just visible on the screen. By keyboard While monitoring the gain level indicator at the top of the screen, operate the [GAIN] control to adjust the sensitivity. By trackball 1. Use the trackball to place the arrow on the gain level indicator at the top of the screen. Level bar Place arrow inside window to adjust gain. GAIN 30 GAIN level indicator 2. Roll the scrollwheel downward to increase the gain or upward to decrease it. 100 levels (0-100) are available. 1-26 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.17 Reducing Sea Clutter Echoes from waves cover the central part of the display with random signals known as sea clutter. The higher the waves, and the higher the antenna above the water, the further the clutter extends. When sea clutter masks the picture, reduce it by the A/C SEA control, either manually or automatically. Note 1: When both sea clutter and rain clutter are reduced, the sensitivity is decreased more than when only one is adjusted. For that reason adjust them carefully. Note 2: The echo average (see 1.27) is useful for reducing reflections from the sea surface. However, high-speed targets are harder to detect than stationary ones when the echo average is active. 1.17.1 Choosing method of adjustment 1. Use the trackball to select SEA AUTO or SEA MAN (whichever is shown) at the top of the display. Level bar Place arrow inside window to adjust A/C SEA. SEA AUTO 30 A/C SEA adjustment method (SEA AUTO or SEA MAN) A/C SEA level indicator 2. Push the left button to display SEA AUTO or SEA MAN as appropriate. 1.17.2 Automatic reduction of sea clutter Auto A/C SEA allows for fine tuning of the A/C SEA circuit, within ±20 dB. Accordingly, with the bar reading set to 100, gain is not lowered to minimum as with manual A/C SEA on close-in ranges. Further, the auto A/C SEA level is low because the average value of the original input echo is low in areas where there are no sea surface reflections. For example, when the ship is alongside a quay and the radar picture shows echoes from both land and sea, you can observe the size of the echoes because the STC curve changes with the size of the echoes. Note: The auto A/C function can erase weak target echoes. Adjust the control carefully, watching the display. By keyboard 1. Select SEA AUTO following the procedure in section 1.17.1. 2. While observing the A/C SEA level indicator, adjust the A/C SEA with the [A/C SEA] control. 100 levels are available. 1-27 1. RADAR OPERATION By trackball 1. Select SEA AUTO following the procedure in section 1.17.1. 2. Use the trackball to place the arrow in the A/C SEA level indicator at the top of the display. 3. While observing the A/C SEA level indicator, roll the scrollwheel downward to increase the A/C SEA or upward to decrease it. 100 levels (0-100) are available. 1.17.3 Manual reduction of sea clutter The A/C SEA control reduces the amplification of echoes at short ranges (where clutter is the greatest) and progressively increases amplification as the range increases, so amplification will be normal at those ranges where there is no sea clutter. The proper setting of the A/C SEA should be such that the clutter is broken up into small dots, and small targets become distinguishable. If the setting is set too low, targets will be hidden in the clutter, while if the setting is too high, both sea clutter and targets will disappear from the display. In most cases adjust the control until clutter has disappeared to leeward, but a little is still visible windward. Be careful not to remove all sea clutter, because you may erase weak echoes. Further, the possibility of losing weak echoes is greater when you use both A/C SEA and A/C RAIN to reduce clutter. Sea clutter at screen center A/C SEA adjusted; sea clutter suppressed By keyboard 1. Select SEA MAN following the procedure in section 1.17.1. 2. Watching the A/C SEA level indicator at the top of the display, adjust the A/C SEA with the [A/C SEA] control. 100 levels (0-100) are available. By trackball 1. Select SEA MAN following the procedure in section 1.17.1. 2. Use the trackball to place the arrow on the A/C SEA level indicator at the top of the display. 3. While observing the A/C SEA level indicator, roll the scrollwheel downward to increase the A/C SEA or upward to decrease it. 100 levels (0-100) are available. 1-28 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.18 Reducing Rain Clutter Use the AUTO RAIN and A/C RAIN to reduced rain clutter. AUTO RAIN reduces rain clutter in the picture and A/C RAIN reduces clutter picked up by the antenna. Note 1: When both sea clutter and rain clutter are reduced the sensitivity is decreased more than when only one is adjusted. For that reason adjust them carefully. Note 2: The echo average (see 1.27) is useful for reducing reflections from the sea surface. However, high-speed targets are harder to detect than stationary ones when the echo average is active. 1.18.1 Automatic reduction of rain clutter Left-click the AUTO RAIN indication at the left side of the screen to select AUTO RAIN setting desired. The higher the number, the greater the degree of rain clutter reduction. OFF turns off the AUTO RAIN feature. Note: AUTO RAIN can also be controlled from the PICTURE box. 1.18.2 Manual reduction of rain clutter The vertical beam width of the antenna is designed to see surface targets even when the ship is rolling. However, by this design the unit will also detect rain clutter (rain, snow, or hail) in the same manner as normal targets. Unwanted echoes are displayed A/C RAIN control adjusted. The A/C RAIN control adjusts the receiver sensitivity as the A/C SEA control does but rather in a longer time period (longer range). The higher the setting the greater the anti-clutter effect. When echoes from precipitation mask solid targets, adjust the A/C RAIN control to split up these unwanted echoes into a speckled pattern, making recognition of solid targets easier. Be careful remove all rain clutter, because you can erase weak echoes. Further, the possibility of losing weak echoes is greater when you use both A/C RAIN and A/C SEA to reduce clutter. Keyboard 1. Use the trackball to put the cursor in the A/C RAIN level indicator at the top right side of the display. 2. While observing the A/C RAIN level indicator, roll the scrollwheel downward to increase the A/C RAIN or upward to decrease it. 100 levels (0-100) are available. Level bar (Shows A/C RAIN level.) Place arrow inside window to adjust A/C RAIN. RAIN 30 1-29 1. RADAR OPERATION Note: The detection range is reduced when the A/C RAIN is used to show targets in rain. Generally, the amount of rain, TX pulse length and TX frequency are factors in determining how the detection range is affected. The figures shown below illustrate this occurrence. 4 mm/h rain (short pulse) Reduction of Range of First Detection (NM) 16 16 mm/h rain - short pulse 4 mm/h rain - short pulse 16 mm/h rain - long pulse 4 mm/h rain - long pulse 14 16 mm/h rain (short pulse) 12 4 mm/h rain (short pulse) 10 16 mm/h rain (long pulse) 16 mm/h rain - short pulse 48mm/h rain - short pulse 16 mm/h rain - long pulse 46mm/h rain - long pulse 10 Original Range of First Detection (NM) 12 14 16 Reduction of Range of First Detection (NM) Reduction of rain to first detection due to rain at S-band 16 16 mm/h rain - short pulse 4 mm/h rain - short pulse 16 mm/h rain - long pulse 4 mm/h rain - long pulse 14 4 mm/h rain (short pulse) 12 4 mm/h rain (long pulse) 10 16 mm/h rain (short pulse) 16 mm/h rain (long pulse) 10 Original Range of First Detection (NM) 12 14 16 Reduction of rain to first detection due to rain at X-band The author thanks the International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) for permission to reproduce Information from its International Standard IEC 62388 ed.1.0 (2007). All such extracts are copyright of IEC, Geneva, Switzerland. All rights reserved. Further information on the IEC is available from www.iec.ch. IEC has no responsibility for the placement and context in which the extracts and contents are reproduced by the author, nor is IEC in any way responsible for the other content or accuracy therein. IEC 62388 ed.1.0 Copyright © 2007 IEC Geneva, Switzerland.www.iec.ch How to read the graph Using the X-band graph as an example, here is how to read the graphs. A radar target detected in rain on the 8 nm range scale can only be detected at the ranges shown below: 4 mm/h rain (short pulse): approx 7.5 nm 16 mm/h rain (short pulse): approx 5.6 nm 4 mm/h rain (long pulse): approx 2.6 nm 16 mm/h rain (long pulse): approx 0.9 nm 1-30 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.19 Measuring Range The range to a target may be measured three ways: with the fixed range rings, with the cursor, or with the VRM. Use the fixed range rings to get an estimate of the range to a target. The rings are the concentric solid circles on the display. The number of rings is automatically set by the current range scale. The distance between the rings is the range ring interval, and the current interval appears at the upper-left position on the screen. To measure the range to a target with the range rings, count the number of rings between the center of the display and the target. Check the range ring interval and estimate the distance of the echo from the inner edge of the nearest ring. 1.19.1 Showing, hiding the fixed range rings 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 2 [MARK]. [MARK] 1 BACK 2 OWN SHIP MARK OFF/MIN/SCALED 3 STERN MARK OFF/ON 4 [PI LINE] 5 ANCHOR WATCH OFF/ON 0.0NM 6 DROP MARK OFF/ON 7 [INS MARK] *1 8 EBL OFFSET BASE STAB GND/STAB HDG/ STAB NORTH 9 [EBL, VRM, CURSOR SET]*2 *1 [BARGE MARK] depending on installation preset. 0 RING *2 IMO and A types show OFF/ON 9 EBL CURSOR BEARING (REL/TRUE) MARK menu 3. Select 0 RING. 4. Select OFF or ON as appropriate then push the left button. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 1-31 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.19.2 Measuring range by the variable range marker (VRM) There are two VRMs, No. 1 and No. 2, which appear as dashed rings so that you can distinguish them from the fixed range rings. The two VRMs can be distinguished from each other by the different lengths of their dashes; the dashes on the No. 2 VRM are longer. 340 No. 1 VRM 350 000 010 020 330 030 320 Target blip 040 310 050 060 300 070 290 280 080 270 090 260 100 250 110 240 120 230 No. 2 VRM 130 140 220 210 150 200 190 180 170 160 45:02 99:59 VRM1 VRM2 >0.66NM< 1.18NM TTG to VRM Measuring range with VRMs By keyboard 1. Press the [VRM ON] key to display either of the VRMs. Successively pressing the [VRM ON] key toggles the active VRM between No. 1 and No. 2. The currently active marker is enclosed with >...<. 2. Operate the VRM rotary control to align the active variable range marker with the inner edge of the target of interest and read its distance at the lower-right corner of the screen. Each VRM remains at the same geographical distance when you operate the [RANGE] key or the RANGE box. This means that the apparent radius of the VRM ring changes in proportion to the selected range scale. 3. Press the [VRM OFF] key to erase each VRM. By trackball 1. Use the trackball to place the arrow in the VRM1 or VRM2 VRM1 box, whichever VRM you want to use. VRM2 2. The guidance box reads "VRM ON/." Push the left button to turn on the VRM. The guidance box now reads "VRM SET L = DELETE /." 3. Push the left button again and the cursor jumps to inside the effective display area. The guidance box now reads "VRM FIX / EXIT." 4. Use the trackball (coarse adjustment) or scrollwheel (fine adjustment) to align the active variable range marker with the inner edge of the target of interest and read its distance at the lower-right corner of the screen. Each VRM remains at the same geographical distance when you operate the [RANGE] key. This means that the apparent radius of the VRM ring changes in proportion to the selected range scale. 5. Push the left button to anchor the VRM and fix its readout, or push the right button to return the VRM to its previous location (range). 6. To erase a VRM, select the appropriate VRM readout box then push the left button until the VRM disappears from the screen. 1-32 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.19.3 VRM unit of measurement (B and C types) 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1.19.4 Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 2 [MARK]. Select 9 [EBL, VRM, CURSOR SET] then push the scrollwheel. Select VRM1 or VRM2 as appropriate and push the scrollwheel. Select unit of measurement desired then push the scrollwheel. Push the right button twice to close the menu. TTG to VRM indication You can show the TTG to VRMs as follows: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 9 [CUSTOMIZE·TEST] to open the CUSTOMIZE·TEST menu. Select 7 [OPERATION]. Select 0 NEXT. Select 3 VRM TTG. Select OFF, 1, 2 or 1+2 as applicable and push the left button. OFF: NO VRM TTG display 1: TTG to VRM1 2: TTG to VRM2 1+2: TTG to VRM1 and VRM2 7. Push the right button four times to close the menu. TTG indication 00:00 VRM1 >3.682NM< VRM and TTG indications 1-33 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.20 Measuring Bearing Use the Electronic Bearing Lines (EBLs) to take bearings of targets. There are two EBLs, No. 1 and No. 2. Each EBL is a straight dashed line extending out from the own ship position up to the circumference of the radar picture. The two EBLs can be distinguished from each other by the different lengths of their dashes; the dashes on the No. 2 EBL are longer. Each EBL carries a range marker, or a short line crossing the EBL at right angles. Its distance from the EBL origin is indicated at the VRM readout whether or not the corresponding VRM is displayed. The range marker changes its position along the EBL with the rotation of the VRM control. To operate this marker, rotate the VRM rotary control on the full keyboard, or put the cursor in the applicable VRM box and roll the scrollwheel. 1.20.1 Measuring bearing By keyboard 1. Press the [EBL ON] key to display either of the EBLs. Successive presses of the [EBL ON] key toggle the active EBL between No. 1 and No. 2. The currently active marker is enclosed with >...<. 2. Operate the EBL rotary control clockwise or counterclockwise until the active EBL bisects the target of interest, and read its bearing at the lower-left corner of the screen. 3. Press the [EBL OFF] key to erase each EBL. By trackball 1. Use the trackball to place the arrow in the EBL1 or EBL2 box, whichever EBL you want to use. EBL1 EBL2 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1-34 EBL boxes The guidance box reads "EBL ON/." Push the left button to turn on the EBL. The guidance box now reads "EBL SET L=DELETE /." Push the left button again and the cursor jumps to inside the effective display area. The guidance box now reads "EBL FIX L=DELETE/." Use the trackball (coarse adjustment) or scrollwheel (fine adjustment) to bisect the target with the EBL. Push the left button to anchor the EBL and fix its readout, or push the right button to return the EBL to its previous location (bearing). To erase an EBL, select the appropriate EBL readout box then push the left button until the EBL disappears from the screen. 1. RADAR OPERATION No. 2 320 330 EBL 310 340 350 000 010 Target blip 020 030 040 050 060 300 070 290 280 080 270 090 260 100 Range markers on EBLs 250 240 110 120 230 130 140 220 210 150 200 EBL1 EBL2 No. 1 EBL 190 >128.0°T< 100.8°T 180 170 160 VRM1 VRM2 >10.2NM< 12.1NM Measuring bearing with EBLs 1.20.2 True or relative bearing The EBL readout is affixed by "R" (relative) if it is relative to own ship's heading, "T" (true) if it is referenced to the north. Available on the IMO and A type radars. True or relative indication is available regardless of presentation mode. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 2 [MARK] to open the MARK menu. 3. Select 9 [EBL, VRM, CURSOR SET] (B, C and W types) or 9 EBL CURSOR BEARING (IMO and A types). For the B, C and W types the menu below appears; go to step 4. For the IMO and A types go to step 5. 4. Select EBL1 or EBL2 as applicable. 5. Select REL or TRUE as applicable. 6. Push the right button twice to close the menu. [EBL, VRM, CURSOR SET] 1 BACK 2 EBL1 REL/TRUE 3 EBL2 REL/TRUE 4 VRM1 NM/SM/km/kyd 5 VRM2 NM/SM/km/kyd 6 CURSOR BEARING REL/TRUE 7 CURSOR RANGE NM/SM/km/kyd 8 [◊ CURSOR SHAPE]* Note: When the gyrocompass heading changes, the EBL and its indication change as follows: Head-up / relative EBL indication and EBL marker are unchanged. Head-up / true EBL indication does not change, however the EBL marker moves accordingly. Course-up / relative EBL indication does not change, however the EBL marker moves accordingly. Course-up / true EBL indication and EBL marker are unchanged. North-up / relative EBL indication does not change, however the EBL marker moves accordingly. North-up / true EBL indication and EBL marker are unchanged. 1-35 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.21 Collision Assessment by Offset EBL The origin of the EBL can be placed anywhere with the trackball to enable measurement of range and bearing between any targets. This function is also useful for assessment of the potential risk of collision. It is possible to read CPA (Closest Point of Approach) by using a VRM as shown in (a) in the illustration on the next page. If the EBL passes through the sweep origin (own ship) as shown in (b) in the illustration on the next page, the target ship is on a collision course. 1.21.1 How to assess risk of collision by the offset EBL By keyboard 1. Press the [EBL ON] key to display or activate an EBL (No. 1 or No. 2). 2. Put the cursor (+) on a target appearing as threatening (A in the illustrated example on the next page) by operating the trackball. 3. Press the [EBL OFFSET] key, and the origin of the active EBL shifts to the cursor position. Press the [EBL OFFSET key] again to anchor the EBL origin. 4. After waiting for a few minutes (at least 3 minutes), operate the EBL rotary control until the EBL bisects the target at the new position (A'). The EBL readout shows the target ship's course, which may be true or relative depending on the EBL bearing reference setting. Note: If relative motion is selected, it is also possible to read CPA by using a VRM as shown in left-hand figure at the top of the next page. If the EBL passes through the sweep origin (own ship) as illustrated in the right-hand figure at the top of then next page, the target ship is on a collision course. 5. To return the EBL origin to the own ship's position, press the [EBL OFFSET] key twice. By trackball 1. Display an EBL, following steps 1-3 in "By trackball" in section 1.20.1. 2. With the cursor inside the effective display area, push the left button, roll the scrollwheel to show "EBL OFFSET / EXIT" in the guidance box then push the left button. 3. Use the trackball to place the offset EBL on a target appearing as threatening (A in the illustrated example on the next page) then push the left button to anchor the EBL origin. 4. After waiting for a few minutes (at least 3 minutes), operate the EBL used in step 1 until it bisects the target at the new position (A'). The EBL readout shows the target ship's course, which may be true or relative depending on the EBL bearing reference setting. To return the EBL origin to the screen center, show "EBL OFFSET / EXIT" in the guidance window then push the left button. 1-36 1. RADAR OPERATION 340 350 000 010 340 020 320 020 030 060 070 290 070 A1 280 080 A1 050 300 060 290 040 310 050 280 010 320 040 310 300 350 000 330 030 330 080 270 090 270 090 260 100 260 100 250 110 240 EBL1 130 140 220 210 150 200 190 180 170 >150.3°T< 160 VRM1 (a) 110 240 120 230 No. 1 EBL 250 No. 1 EBL >3.85NM< EBL1 120 230 130 140 220 210 150 200 190 180 170 >138.2°T< 160 VRM1 (b) >3.85NM< Collision assessment by offset EBL 1.21.2 Point of reference for origin point of offset EBL The origin point of the offset EBL can be ground stabilized (geographically fixed), north stabilized (true) or referenced to own ship’s heading (relative). 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 2 [MARK] to open the MARK menu. [MARK] 1 BACK 2 OWN SHIP MARK OFF/MIN/SCALED 3 STERN MARK OFF/ON 4 [PI LINE] 5 ANCHOR WATCH OFF/ON 0.0NM 6 DROP MARK OFF/ON 7 [INS MARK] *1 8 EBL OFFSET BASE STAB GND/STAB HDG/ STAB NORTH 9 [EBL, VRM, CURSOR SET]*2 *1 [BARGE MARK] depending on installation preset. 0 RING *2 IMO and A types show OFF/ON 9 EBL CURSOR BEARING (REL/TRUE) MARK menu 3. Select 8 EBL OFFSET BASE. 4. Select STAB GND, STAB HDG or STAB NORTH as applicable. STAB GND: Reference to latitude and longitude. Origin position is always fixed regardless of your ship's movement. STAB HDG: Reference to heading. The relationship between origin position and own position is kept always. STAB NORTH: Reference to North. The origin position changes with North position. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 1-37 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.22 Measuring Range and Bearing Between Two Targets By keyboard 1. Press the [EBL OFFSET] key. Operate the trackball to place the origin of the No. 1 EBL, for example, on a target of interest (target 1 in the illustrated example). 2. Operate the EBL rotary control until the EBL passes through another target of interest (target 2). 3. Operate the VRM rotary control until the range marker on the EBL is on the inside edge of target 2. The active VRM readout at the lower-right corner of the screen indicates the distance between the two targets. 4. You can repeat the same procedure on third and fourth targets (targets 3 and 4) by using the No. 2 EBL and the No. 2 VRM. Bearing is shown relative to own ship with suffix "R" or as a true bearing with suffix "T" depending on EBL relative/true settings of EBL CURSOR BEARING in the MARK menu. To return the EBL origin to the screen center, press the [EBL OFFSET] key again. By trackball 1. Display an EBL, following the No. 2 Range steps 1-3 in section 1.20.1. EBL Marker 2. With the cursor inside the Range Target 2 effective display area, push the Target 4 No.1 Marker left button, roll the scrollwheel EBL R2 Target 1 to show "EBL OFFSET / EXIT" Target 3 EBL in the guidance box then push origin the left button. 3. Use the trackball to put the cursor on target 1 then push >0.50NM< >140.0°R< 0.98NM 335.2°R the left button. 4. Operate the No. 1 VRM until Range/bearing the range marker on the EBL Range/bearing between targets 3 and 4 aligns with target 2. The active between targets 1 and 2 VRM readout at the lower-right corner of the screen indicates the distance between the two targets. 5. You can repeat the same procedure on third and fourth targets (targets 3 and 4) by using the No. 2 EBL and the No. 2 VRM. 340 350 000 010 020 330 030 320 040 310 050 060 300 070 290 280 080 270 090 260 100 250 110 240 120 230 130 140 220 EBL1 EBL2 210 150 200 190 180 170 160 VRM1 VRM2 To return the EBL origin to the screen center, show "EBL OFFSET / EXIT" in the guidance window then push the left button. 1-38 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.23 Target Alarm The target alarm serves to alert the navigator to targets (ships, landmasses, etc.) entering a specific area, with audiovisual alarms. CAUTION • The alarm should not be relied upon as the sole means for detecting possible collision situations. • A/C SEA, A/C RAIN and GAIN controls should be properly adjusted to be sure the alarm system does not overlook target echoes. The target alarm zone has a fixed width of 0.5 nm in the radial direction (depth) and is adjustable from 3.0 to 6.0 nm (guard zone 1) and any distance (guard zone 2). On the Non-IMO radar the boundaries can be set at any distance. On any radar type the sector of the zone can be set from 0 to 360 degrees in any direction. 1.23.1 How to set a target alarm The procedure below shows how to set a target alarm using the figure below as an example. 1. Left-click ALARM1 or ALARM2 box, whichever alarm you wish to put the cursor jumps into the effective display area and "SET" appears inside the ALARM box selected. ALARM 1 ALARM 2 ALARM boxes 2. Use the trackball to put the cursor on point "A" then push the left button. 3. Use the trackball to put the cursor on point "B" then push the left button. "WORK" replaces "SET" in the ALARM box. The target alarm zone’s lines are shown in dashed lines. 330 340 350 000 010 020 Target alarm zone 030 320 040 310 Other alarm zone examples 050 060 300 290 Point A 070 280 080 270 090 260 100 250 110 240 Point A Point B Point B Point B 120 230 Point A 130 140 220 210 200 150 190 180 170 160 Target alarm zone 1-39 1. RADAR OPERATION Note 1: If you wish to create a target alarm zone having a 360-degree coverage around own ship, set point "B" in almost the same direction as point "A." Note 2: Two target alarm zones may be set. Note however that the 2nd target alarm zone is available only when the 1st target alarm zone is active. Note 3: When the target alarm zone is not within the range in use the indication UP RNG appears to the right of the ALARM box. In this case select a range that will display the target alarm zone. 1.23.2 Acknowledging the target alarm A target in the target alarm zone produces both visual (flashing) and audible (beep) alarms. To silence the audio alarm, press the [ALARM ACK] key on the full keyboard or select the appropriate ALARM box then push the left button. The ALARM box shows "ALARMx ACK." This will deactivate the audio alarm but will not stop the flashing of the offending target. To reactivate the audio alarm, press the [ALARM ACK] key again or select the ALARM box then push the left button. (When an external buzzer is connected, the audio alarm does not stop until the alarm zone itself is deactivated.) The ALARM box shows "ALARMx WORK." 1.23.3 Deactivating a target alarm Left-click ALARM1 or ALARM2 box, whichever alarm you wish to deactivate, until the alarm status in the ALARM box disappears. In this radar deactivation of the target alarm zone 1 deactivates target alarm zone 2 1-40 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.23.4 Target alarm attributes You may select the echo strength level that triggers the alarm, the condition that generates the alarm and the volume of the audio alarm as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 3 [ALARM]. [ALARM] 1 BACK 2 TARGET ALARM MODE IN/OUT 3 TARGET ALARM LEVEL 1/2/3/4 4 WATCH ALARM OFF/6M/10M/ 12M/15M/20M 5 ALARM SOUND LEVEL OFF/LOW/MID/HIGH 6 [ALARM OUT1] 7 [ALARM OUT2] 8 [ALARM OUT3] 9 [ALARM OUT4] 0 [PRIMARY ALARM] ALARM menu 3. Select 2 TARGET ALARM MODE. 4. Select IN or OUT as appropriate. IN: Targets entering the zone trigger the alarms. OUT: Targets exiting the zone trigger the alarms. Inward target alarm 5. 6. 7. 8. Outward target alarm Alarm types Select 3 TARGET ALARM LEVEL. Select echo strength level that will trigger the alarm. "1" is highest strength. Select 5 ALARM SOUND LEVEL. Select audio alarm volume, among OFF, LOW, MID and HIGH. Note: 5 ALARM SOUND LEVEL also sets the level of the audio alarm for the watch alarm. 9. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 1-41 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.24 Off-Centering the Display Own ship position, or sweep origin, can be displaced to expand the view field without switching to a larger range scale. The sweep origin can be off-centered to the cursor position, but not more than 75% of the range in use; if the cursor is set beyond 75% of the range scale, the sweep origin will be off-centered to the point of 75% of the limit. This feature is not available on the 96 nm range or in the true motion mode. If the conning position is outside the effective radar display, some parts of the bearing scale are not shown. For details, see section 1.50. To off-center the radar picture, do the following: By keyboard 1. Use the trackball to put the cursor at a position where you wish to move the sweep origin. 2. Press the [OFF CENTER] key. Then, the sweep origin is off-centered to the cursor position. 3. To cancel off-centering, press the [OFF CENTER] key again. By trackball 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to display "OFF CENTER / EXIT" in the guidance box. 2. Use the trackball to put the cursor Cursor where you want to locate the screen Put cursor where desired Off-centered display center. and do appropriate 3. Push the left button to off center the OFF CENTER procedure sweep origin. 4. To cancel the off-center function, push the left button when the guidance box reads "OFF CENTER / EXIT." Note: When the conditions shown below are met, offcenter cannot be cancelled. This is because the radar antenna position is located at a position greater than 75% of the effective radar display. - Own ship marker is large - The distance between antenna position and conning position is large - Short-distance display range. To cancel the offcenter first select a larger range then cancel the offcenter. 1-42 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.25 Interference Rejector Mutual radar interference may occur in the vicinity of another shipborne radar operating in the same frequency band. It is seen on the screen as a number of bright spikes either in irregular patterns or in the form of usually curved spoke-like dotted lines extending from the center to the edge of the picture. Activating the interference rejector circuit can reduce this type of interference. The interference rejector is a kind of signal correlation circuit. It compares the received signals over successive transmissions and reduces randomly occurring signals. There are three levels of interference rejection depending on the number of transmissions that are correlated. Interference To adjust the interference rejector, left-click IR indication at the left side of the screen to select rejection level. "3" provides the highest degree of reduction. Note: The interference rejector can also be adjusted from the PICTURE box. 1.26 Echo Stretch The echo stretch feature enlarges targets in the range and bearing directions to make them easier to see, and it is available on any range. There are three types of echo stretch, 1, 2 and 3, and the higher the number the greater the amount of stretch. Note: The echo stretch magnifies not only small target pips but also returns (clutter) from sea surface, rain and radar interference. For this reason, make sure these types of interference have been sufficiently reduced before activating the echo stretch. To set echo stretch, left-click the ES indication at the left side of the display. Note: Echo stretch can also be adjusted from the PICTURE box. 1-43 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.27 Echo Averaging The echo averaging feature effectively reduces sea clutter. Echoes received from stable targets such as ships appear on the screen at almost the same position every rotation of the antenna. On the other hand, unstable echoes such as sea clutter appear at random positions. To distinguish real target echoes from sea clutter, echoes are averaged over successive picture frames. If an echo is solid and stable over successive frames, it is presented in its normal intensity. Sea clutter is averaged over successive scans and its brilliance reduced, making it easier to discriminate real targets from sea clutter. Echo averaging uses scan-to-scan signal correlation technique based on the true motion over the ground of each target. Thus, small stationary targets such as buoys will be shown while reducing random echoes such as sea clutter. True echo averaging is not however effective for picking up small targets running at high speeds over the ground. Note 1: With echo average active it is harder to detect high-speed targets than stationary ones. Note 2: Do not use the echo averaging function under heavy pitching and rolling; loss of targets can result. Note 3: Echo averaging can be used without a heading sensor. For further details, contact your dealer. Note 4: Echo averaging requires heading, position and speed data. Before using the echo averaging function, reduce sea clutter with the A/C SEA control. Leave a little sea clutter on the screen so as not to erase weak targets. Then, do as follows: Left-click the EAV indication at the left side of the display. OFF: 1, 2: 3: Echo averaging OFF Detects targets hidden in sea clutter. "2" is more effective than "1" in detecting targets hidden in strong sea clutter. However, "1" is more effective than "2" in displaying high-speed targets. Select the setting best suited to current conditions. For effective monitoring of high-speed craft, you should use "2" together with Wiper. Stably displays unstable targets; distinguishes high-speed craft from sea clutter. Note: Echo averaging can also be adjusted from the PICTURE box. 1-44 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.28 Noise Rejector White noise may show itself on the screen as random "speckles" spread over the entire radar image. You can remove this noise as follows: 1. Right-click the PICTURE box at the left side of the screen to open the PICTURE menu. [PICTURE MENU] 1 INT REJECT OFF/1/2/3 2 ECHO STRETCH OFF/1/2/3 3 ECHO AVERAGE OFF/1/2/3 4 NOISE REJ OFF/ON 5 AUTO STC OFF/ON 6 AUTO RAIN OFF/1/2/3/4 7 VIDEO CONTRAST 1/2/3/4/ A/B/C 8 [PULSE] 9 [CONDITION] 0 DEFAULT NO/SAVE/USER/ FACTORY 2. Select 4 NOISE REJ. 3. Select ON or OFF as appropriate. 4. Push the right button to close the menu. 1-45 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.29 Wiper The wiper feature automatically reduces the brilliance of weak signals (noise, sea clutter, rain clutter, etc.) and unwanted signals such as radar interference to clear the picture of unwanted echoes. Its effect depends on the wiper setting used and whether each averaging is turned on or off, as described below. Echo averaging and wiper states and wiper effect Echo averaging OFF Echo averaging ON (1/2/3) Wiper setting 1 Condition A Condition A Wiper setting 2 Condition A Condition B Condition A: The brilliance of unwanted weak echoes, such as noise, sea clutter and rain clutter, is reduced to clear up the picture. The difference between wiper setting "1" and "2" is that brilliance is lowered more slowly in "2". Condition B: Echo averaging is automatically activated when the wiper feature is turned on, allowing you to instantly see how the picture is affected with echo averaging turned off and turned on. To activate the wiper feature, do the following: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 1 [ECHO] to open the ECHO menu. [ECHO] 1 BACK ND 2 2 ECHO REJ OFF/ON 3 TUNE INITIALIZE 4 PM OFF/ON 5 SART OFF/ON 6 WIPER OFF/1/2 7 ECHO AREA*1 CIRCLE/WIDE/ALL 8 [PICTURE SELECT] *1 Not available on IMO or A type 9 STC RANGE +00 ECHO menu 3. Select 6 WIPER. 4. Select OFF, 1 or 2 as appropriate. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 1-46 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.30 Target Trails The trails of the radar echoes of targets may be displayed in the form of synthetic afterglow. Target trails are shown either relative or true and may be sea or ground stabilized. True motion trails require a compass signal, and position and speed data. 1.30.1 True or relative trails You may display echo trails in true or relative motion. Relative trails show relative movements between targets and own ship. True motion trails present true target movements in accordance with their over-the-ground speeds and courses. Note: When true trail is selected on the RM mode, the TRAIL MODE box is shown in blue. The reference for the past position displays for AIS and TT is also switched whenever trail reference is switched. (a) True target trails (No smearing of stationary targets) (b) Relative target trails (Targets moving relative to own ship) 1. Right-click the TRAIL MODE box at the bottom right corner of the screen to open the TRAIL menu. [TRAIL MENU] 1 TRAIL MODE REL/TRUE 2 TRAIL GRAD SINGLE/MULTI 3 NARROW TRAIL*3 OFF/1/2 4 TRAIL LEVEL 1/2/3/4 5 TRAIL RESTART OFF/ON 6 TRAIL COPY OFF/ON 7 OS TRAIL OFF/1/2 8 TRAIL LENGTH*1 NORMAL/12H/24H/48H 9 TRAIL HIDE*1 START 00:00 END 00:00 0 [TRAIL COLOR]*1,*2 *1 Shown when 8 TRAIL LENGTH is selected to other than "NORMAL". Other than IMO and A types. W-type does not show 48H. *2 B and C types only *3 B, C and W types 2. Select 1 TRAIL MODE. 3. Select TRUE or REL. 4. Push the right button to close the menu. 1-47 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.30.2 Trail time Trail time, the trail plotting interval, may be selected as follows: 1. Select the arrow in the TRAIL MODE box at the bottom right corner of the screen. * TRAIL ** * TRUE-S(or -G) or REL S: Sea stablized G: Ground stabilized ** Trail time setting TRAIL MODE box 2. Push the left button to select the trail time as below. Control Left button Available setting OFF, 15 sec, 30 sec, 1 min, 3 min, 6 min, 15 min, 30 min, CONT(inuous) Scrollwheel OFF, 15 sec, 30 sec, 1-30 min (30 sec intervals), CONT(inuous) The timer above the TRAIL MODE box counts up the trail time and is erased once the terminal count is reached. For example, if the trail time is six minutes, the timer is erased when trails have been plotted six minutes. The maximum time for continuous plotting is 99:59. 1.30.3 Trail gradation The afterglow can be selected in a single tone or gradual shading. Monotone (Single) Gradual shading (Multi) Trail gradation 1. 2. 3. 4. 1-48 Right-click the TRAIL MODE box to display the TRAIL menu. Select 2 TRAIL GRAD. Select SINGLE (single) or MULTI (multiple) as appropriate. Push the right button to close the menu. 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.30.4 Saving, copying target trails By turning on the functions TRAIL RESTART and TRAIL COPY, you may continue painting target trails whenever the range scale is changed. The amount of range change determines how the radar paints trails. See the table below for details. Note however that if the previous range is restored within 10 seconds and the amount of range change is within 1/3, trails continue as before. If trails become difficult to view, you may delete them. For details, see section 1.30.10. Amount of range change Large (ex. 3 nm→12 nm) How trails are processed Trails continue on targets that were within the previous range scale. Trails are not initiated for targets that were not within the previous range. Trails continue on targets that were in the previous range scale. Trails are restarted. Within 1/3 of previous range (ex. 3 nm→1.5 nm) Within 1/4 of previous range (ex. 3 nm→0.75 nm) No trail generated for target not within previous range (a) Previous range (b) New range 1. Right-click the TRAIL MODE box to display the TRAIL menu. 2. Select 5 TRAIL RESTART. 3. Select ON or OFF as appropriate. ON: Trails start extending on the newly selected range. OFF: Trails extend only on the range where they were initiated. 4. Select 6 TRAIL COPY. 5. Select ON or OFF as appropriate. 6. Push the right button to close the menu. 1-49 1. RADAR OPERATION The relationship between trail restart and trail copy depends on their status, as shown in the table below. 1.30.5 Trail restart Trail copy Trail status ON ON Range changed while trail is ON: Trails continue on targets within previous range. ON OFF Range changed while trail is ON: Trails within the previous range are erased then trails are restarted. OFF OFF/ON • Range changed while trail is ON: New trails not initiated. (Trails from previous range are stored in memory.) • Range returned to previous range: Trails continues on targets stored in memory. • Trails turned ON: Trails stored in memory are erased. (See section 1.30.10.) (Trails stored in the memory are erased and trails are then initiated on new range.) Trail level The level (intensity) of the afterglow that extends from radar targets may be selected as below. 1. Right-click the TRAIL MODE box to display the TRAIL menu. 2. Select 4 TRAIL LEVEL. 3. Select level desired. The higher the number the greater the intensity of the afterglow. 4. Push the right button to close the menu. 1.30.6 Narrow trails (B, C and W types) Target trails may be painted with thinner lines if desired. This can be useful when there are a lot of targets on the screen and it is hard to distinguish one from another. 1. 2. 3. 4. 1-50 Right-click the TRAIL MODE box to display the TRAIL menu. Select 3 NARROW TRAIL. Select OFF, 1 or 2 as appropriate. "2" is thinner than "1". Push the right button to close the menu. 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.30.7 Longer trails (B, C and W types) In addition to the trail times mentioned in section 1.30.2, you may also extend trails 12 ,24 or 48 hours. 1. Right-click the TRAIL MODE box to display the TRAIL menu. 2. Select 8 TRAIL LENGTH. 3. Select NORMAL, 12H, 24H or 48H as appropriate. Note: 48H not available with W-type. NORMAL: Trails are extended according to the setting made on the TRAIL MODE box. 12H: Extend trails for 12 hours. 24H: Extend trails for 24 hours. 48H: Extend trails for 48 hours (not available on W type). 4. If you selected 12 hour, 24 hour or 48 hour, 9 TRAIL HIDE appears together with start and end times. This item allows you to designate a time period in which no trails will be extended. Enter time frame at START and END. 5. Push the right button to close the menu. 1.30.8 Temporarily removing trails from the display You may wish to temporarily remove all trails from the display. Trails are removed but are continued internally. By keyboard: Press the [CANCEL TRAILS] key to show OFF in the TRAIL MODE box. By trackball: Left-click the TRAIL MODE box to display OFF in the box. 1.30.9 Trail stabilization in true motion True motion trails may be ground stabilized or sea stabilized. The TRAIL box shows current stabilization as TRUE-G or TRUE-S. To change stabilization mode, open the SPEED menu and set SHIP SPEED to BT (ground stabilization) or WT (sea stabilization). 1.30.10 Erasing trails All trails may be erased (including those in the memory) and restarted to start trails fresh. By keyboard: Press and hold down the [CANCEL TRAILS] key until trails disappear. By trackball: Left-click the TRAIL MODE box until all trails disappear. 1-51 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.30.11 Preventing sea clutter in true trails You can prevent the display of sea clutter in true trails about your ship to clear the radar picture. Your ship's trails can also be shown or hidden. 1. Right-click the TRAIL MODE box to show the TRAIL menu. 2. Select 7 OS TRAIL and push the left button. 3. Roll the scrollwheel to select OFF, 1 or 2 as appropriate, referring to the table below. Option OFF Show own ship's trail No Yes No Prevent sea clutter in true trails No Yes Yes 4. Push the right button to close the menu. 1.31 PI (Parallel Index) Lines PI lines are useful for keeping a constant distance between own ship and a coastline or a partner ship when navigating. Up to six sets of PI lines are available depending on the maximum number of PI lines selected on the menu. Max. 1 PI line: Six sets of PI lines (PI1 - PI6) Max. 2, 3 or 6 PI lines: Four sets of PI lines (PI1 – PI4) PI lines You may control the orientation and interval of the PI lines from the PI line box, which is at the lower left corner. 1.31.1 Displaying, erasing PI lines By keyboard 1. With the menu closed, press the [INDEX LINE] key. The guidance box shows "DISP PI LINE/." 2. While watching the PI line number box, press and hold the [INDEX LINE] key to select a PI line. Press the key again to display or erase the PI line selected. PI line number PI line orientation PI line interval PI 1 ON Status (ON or OFF) 032.0°T (Boxes not shown when 5.60NM PI line is OFF.) PI line boxes By trackball 1. Select the PI line number box and use the trackball to select a PI line number. 2. Push the left button to turn the PI line on or off as appropriate. 1-52 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.31.2 Adjusting PI line orientation, PI line interval 1. If not already displayed, show a PI line, referring to section 1.31.1. 2. Use the trackball to place the arrow in PI 1 ON the PI line orientation box. PI line orientation 3. Roll the scrollwheel to adjust the PI 032.0°T PI line interval line orientation, between 5.60NM 000.0-359.9(°T). Enter a negative value to move the PI line to the opposite side of the PI line passing through the own ship position. 4. Use the trackball to put the cursor in the PI line interval box. 5. Roll the scrollwheel to adjust the PI line interval. 1.31.3 PI line bearing reference PI line bearing reference may be relative to own ship’s heading (Relative) or referenced to North (True) as below. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 2 [MARK]. 3. Select 4 [PI LINE]. [PI LINE] 1 BACK 2 PI LINE BEARING REL/TRUE 3 PI LINE 1/2/3/6 4 PI LINE MODE PARALLEL/PERPENDIC. 5 RESET PI LINE NO/YES 4. Select 2 PI LINE BEARING. 5. Select REL or TRUE as appropriate. 6. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 1-53 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.31.4 Maximum number of PI lines to display The maximum number of PI lines to display may be selected from 1, 2, 3 or 6 lines as below. The actual number of lines visible may be less depending on line interval. For the W specification radar, you may specify the number of lines for two sets of PI lines – the menu displays 4 PI LINE1 and 5 PI LINE2. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1.31.5 Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 2 [MARK] to open the MARK menu. Select 4 [PI LINE]. Select 3 PI LINE. Select 1, 2, 3 or 6 as appropriate. Push the right button twice to close the menu. PI line orientation PI lines orientation may be selected from parallel or perpendicular. This function is available when 3 PI LINE in the PI LINE menu is set for other than "1". 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1.31.6 Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 2 [MARK] to open the MARK menu. Select 4 [PI LINE]. Select 4 PI LINE MODE. Select PARALLEL or PERPENDIC. as appropriate. Push the right button twice to close the menu. Resetting PI lines You can automatically return PI lines to default orientation, 0-degrees for parallel orientation, 90-degrees for perpendicular orientation. This is faster than doing it manually. From the menu 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 2 [MARK] to open the MARK menu. Select 4 [PI LINE]. Select 5 PI LINE MODE. Select YES. Push the right button twice to close the menu. From the PI line number box Put the cursor on the PI line number box and long-push the left button. 1-54 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.32 Origin Mark You can mark any prominent target or a point of particular interest using the origin mark feature. Twenty origin marks may be entered: 10 standard origin marks (with number) and one each of the 10 symbol origin marks. The marks may be geographically fixed (ground stabilized) or sea stabilized. To display the origin marks, heading signal and own ship position data are required. 1.32.1 Entering origin marks 1. Use the trackball to select the MARK box at the left side of the screen. The guidance box now reads "MARK SELECT / MARK MENU." MARK Mark type last selected, mark number -> + MARK box 2. Push the right button to open the MARK menu. [MARK MENU] 1 ORIGIN MARK STAB GND/SEA 2 MARK KIND ORIGIN MARK(No. )/ ORIGIN MARK(SYM)/ MAP MARK/ WP 1~50/ WP 51~ 100/ WP 101~150/ WP 151~198/ OWN SHIP SHAPE 8 MARK POSN CURSOR/OS/L/L 00°000.00 N 000°000.00 E 9 MAP DISPLAY OFF/ON 0 MAP MARK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT * Not available on IMO or A type MARK menu 3. Select 2 MARK KIND. 4. Select ORIGIN MARK (No.) or ORIGIN MARK (SYM) as appropriate. Select ORIGIN MARK (No.) to inscribe standard origin mark ( ) plus mark number; ORIGIN MARK (SYM) to inscribe desired origin mark symbol (no number). 5. Push the left button. 6. Push the right button to close the menu. The guidance box now reads "MARK SELECT / MARK MENU." 1-55 1. RADAR OPERATION 7. With the cursor choosing the MARK box, Select mark number desired ("ORIGIN MARK(No.)" selected at step 4) or origin mark symbol ("ORIGIN MARK(SYM)" selected at step 4) then push the left button. The following origin marks are available. Origin mark (symbols) 8. Push the left button again. The cursor jumps into the effective display area and the guidance box now reads "MARK / EXIT." 9. Use the trackball to put the cursor on the location desired. 10. Push the left button to inscribe the origin mark at the cursor location. The bearing and range from the origin mark to the cursor location are shown just below the MARK box. MARK Bearing and range from origin mark to cursor 162.5°T -> + 11.7NM Mark box, showing bearing and range from origin mark • To inscribe a different standard origin mark number or symbol origin mark, repeat steps 7-10. (ORIGIN MARK(No.) or (ORIGIN MARK(SYM) should be preselected as appropriate.) • To quit entering origin marks, push the right button when the guidance box reads "MARK / EXIT." • Origin mark data reads "- - -.-" when the cursor is placed outside the effective display area. • "ORIGIN" appear to the right of the MARK box when an origin mark item is selected. 1-56 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.32.2 Origin mark stabilization Origin marks may be geographically fixed (ground stabilized) or moving (sea stabilized). 1. Right-click the MARK box to open the MARK menu. [MARK MENU] 1 ORIGIN MARK STAB GND/SEA 2 MARK KIND ORIGIN MARK(No. )/ ORIGIN MARK(SYM)/ MAP MARK/ WP 1~50/ WP 51~ 100/ WP 101~150/ WP 151~198/ OWN SHIP SHAPE 8 MARK POSN CURSOR/OS/L/L 00°000.00 N 000°000.00 E 9 MAP DISPLAY OFF/ON 0 MAP MARK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT * Not available on IMO or A type MARK menu 2. Select 1 ORIGIN MARK STAB then push the scrollwheel. 3. Select GND or SEA as appropriate. 4. Push the right button to close the menu. 1.32.3 Deleting individual origin marks The procedure below shows how to delete individual origin marks. Note that origin marks cannot be deleted collectively. 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to display "MARK DELETE / EXIT" in the guidance box. 2. Use the trackball to put the cursor on the origin mark you wish to erase. 3. Push the left button or the scrollwheel to erase the mark. 4. To erase another mark, repeat steps 2 and 3. 5. To finish, push the right button when the guidance box reads "MARK DELETE / EXIT." 1-57 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.33 Zoom The zoom function enlarges an area of interest as large as twice the normal viewing size, in the text window. To use the zoom display, it must be turned on in the DATA BOX menu. For further details, see section 1.42. Zoom is not available when the tracked target data setting is "LARGE". 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to display "ZOOM / EXIT" in the guidance box. 2. Use the trackball to select the location to zoom. 3. Push the left button or the scrollwheel. A rectangle inscribes the location zoomed and the zoom display at the right side of the screen shows the zoomed picture. Zoom Area Zoom display (Appears in box above when nav data is turned off.) Zoom area selected with the cursor Data Box Zoom display To quit the zoom display, push the left button when the guidance box reads "ZOOM / EXIT." 1-58 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.34 Markers 1.34.1 Heading line The heading line is a line from the own ship position to the outer edge of the radar display area and appears at zero degrees on the bearing scale in head-up mode; it changes the orientation depending on the ship orientation in north-up and true motion modes. Temporarily erasing the heading line To temporarily extinguish the heading line to look at targets existing dead ahead of own ship, press the [HL OFF] key on the keyboard, or use the trackball to select the HL OFF box at the bottom left corner of the display then push the left button. In addition to the heading line, the stern marker and all graphics within the effective display are also erased. To redisplay the heading line, etc., release the key or the left button. 1.34.2 Stern marker The stern marker, which is a dot-and-dash line, appears opposite to the heading line. To display or erase this marker do the following: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 1.34.3 Left-click the MENU box to open the MAIN menu. Select MARK to show the MARK menu. Select 3 STERN MARK. Select OFF or ON as appropriate. Push the right button twice to close the menu. North marker The north marker appears as a short dashed line. In the head-up mode, the north marker moves around the bearing scale in accordance with the compass signal. 1-59 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.34.4 Own ship symbol The own ship symbol marks own position on the display. It can be turned on or off and its configuration selected from the MARK menu. Two configurations are available: minimized symbol and scaled symbol. The scaled symbol is scaled to indicate the length and beam of the vessel. If the largest dimension of the symbol gets smaller than 6 mm, the symbol will disappear and own ship will be with a minimized symbol. Ship’s dimensions should be entered at installation to use the scaled ship symbol. Antenna position Heading line Heading line Beam line Scaled symbol 1. 2. 3. 4. 1-60 Beam line Minimized symbol Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 2 to show the MARK MENU. Select OFF, MIN or SCALED as appropriate. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.34.5 Barge marker You may mark the locations of barges on the display with icons. This feature is available with an installation preset. Set up barge information as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 2 [MARK] to show the MARK menu. 3. Select 7 [BARGE MARK]. [BARGE INFORMATION] 1 BACK 2 BARGE MARK OFF/ON 3 BARGE SIZE LENGTH 0ft WIDTH 0ft 4 ARRANGEMENT 4. 5. 6. 7. BARGE INFORMATION menu Select 2 [BARGE MARK] and push the left button. Select ON and push the left button. Select 3 BARGE SIZE and push the left button. Enter length (three digits) and width (two digits) of barge. Select 4 ARRANGEMENT and push the left button. This item lets you set a single barge or a barge chain. Select one of the five arrangements and push the scrollwheel. Select number of barges (max. 9) to display. As you roll the scrollwheel the squares light or extinguish and the number of barges selected appears at the right side. Push the right button twice to close the menu. Barge Far left is 1st row 1.34.6 INS marker You can get predicted position data by connecting this radar to an INS. 1. 2. 3. 4. Open the menu and select 2 [MARK]. Spin the scrollwheel to select 7 [INS MARK] and 7 PREDICTOR. Select ON. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 1-61 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.35 Automatic Picture Setup According to Navigation Purpose Every time your navigating environment or task changes, you must adjust the radar, which can be a nuisance in a busy situation. Instead of changing radar settings case by case, it is possible to assign the function keys to provide optimum settings for often encountered situations. The radar's internal computer offers several picture setup options to be assigned to each function key for your specific navigating requirements. For instance, one of the functions is assigned the ship detecting function and labeled SHIP on the on the PICTURE box. By choosing SHIP, the radar will be instantly set for optimum detection of ships. Four user-programmable setups are also provided (labeled PICTURE1-PICTURE4), so that you may have the radar automatically adjusted to those conditions that are not covered by the provided setup options. Below are the preset picture setup options provided with this radar. Picture setup options description Label NEAR NEAR BUOY HARBOR ROUGH SEA Description Optimum setting for short range detection using a range scale of 3 nm or less on calm seas Optimum setting for detecting navigation buoys, small vessels and other small surface objects at close range Optimum setting for short range navigation in a harbor area, using a range scale of 1.5 nm or less Optimum setting for rough weather or heavy rain Label FAR FAR BUOY COAST SHIP Description Optimum setting for long range detection using a range scale of 6 nm or larger Optimum setting for detecting navigation buoys, small vessels and other small surface objects at long range For coastal navigation using a range scale of 12 nm or less Optimum setting for detecting vessels Each picture setup option defines a combination of several radar settings for achieving optimum setup for a particular navigating situation. Those involved are interference rejector, echo stretch, echo average, noise rejector, automatic anti-sea and anti-rain clutters, video contrast, and pulselength and sea and radar conditions. Adjusting these features from the PICTURE menu changes the original function key settings. To restore the original settings for a particular picture setup option, it is necessary to select the default setting. For this reason, we recommended that you use the user-programmable function sets when frequent adjustment of the radar picture is necessary. 1-62 1. RADAR OPERATION Picture setup options and default settings for X-band (12 kW/25 kW) and S-band (30 kW) radars PICTURE 1 PICTURE 2 PICTURE 3 PICTURE 4 NEAR FAR NEAR BUOY FAR BUOY ROUGH SEA SHIP HARBOR COAST 1 INT REJECT PICTURE 1 PICTURE 2 PICTURE 3 PICTURE 4 NEAR FAR NEAR BUOY FAR BUOY ROUGH SEA SHIP HARBOR COAST P/L on 0.5 nm S1 S2 S1 S1 S1 S2 S2 S2 S1 S1 S1 S1 2 ECHO STRETCH OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF P/L on 0.75 nm S2 S2 S2 S2 S1 M1 M1 M1 S1 S2 S1 S2 3 ECHO AVERAGE OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 8 PULSE P/L on 1.5 nm S2 M1 S2 S2 S2 M1 M1 M1 S2 M1 S2 M1 P/L on 3 nm M1 M2 M1 M1 M1 M3 M2 M3 M1 M2 M1 M2 4 NOISE REJ OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF ON OFF ON OFF OFF OFF OFF P/L on 6 nm M2 M3 M2 M2 M2 M2 M3 M3 M3 5 AUTO STC OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF P/L on 12-24 nm M3 6 AUTO RAIN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 7 VIDEO CONTRAST 1-B 2-B 1-B 2-A 2-B 3-B 2-B 3-B 2-A 2-B 2-B 2-B 9 CONDITION Sea Cond. Low Level Echo Picture setup options and default settings for X-band (50 kW) and S-band (60 kW) radars PICTURE 1 PICTURE 2 PICTURE 3 PICTURE 4 NEAR FAR NEAR BUOY FAR BUOY ROUGH SEA SHIP 1 INT REJECT PICTURE 1 PICTURE 2 PICTURE 3 PICTURE 4 NEAR FAR NEAR BUOY FAR BUOY ROUGH SEA SHIP P/L on 0.5 nm 2 ECHO STRETCH OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF P/L on 0.75 nm 3 ECHO AVERAGE OFF OFF OFF OFF 8 PULSE P/L on 1.5 nm M1 M1 M1 M1 M1 P/L on 3 nm M1 M2 M1 M1 M1 M2 M2 M2 M1 M2 4 NOISE REJ OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF P/L on 6 nm M2 M2 M2 M2 M2 M2 5 AUTO STC OFF OFF ON OFF OFF ON OFF ON ON OFF P/L on 12-24 nm 6 AUTO RAIN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 7 VIDEO CONTRAST 1-B 2-B 1-B 2-A 2-B 3-B 2-B 3-B 2-A 3-B 9 CONDITION Sea Cond. Low Level Echo 1-63 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.35.1 Selecting a picture setup option You may select a picture setup options as follows: Left-click PICTURE box at the left side of the screen to select picture setup option desired. NEAR BUOY* * Other possible indications: NEAR, FAR, FAR BUOY, ROUGH SEA, SHIP, HARBOR, COAST, PICTURE 1 - PICTURE 4 1.35.2 Programming and saving picture setups User-programmable picture setups and they are provided in the PICTURE box. Normally, PICTURE1-PICTURE4 are for programming but you may program any other picture item as desired. You may program and save them as below. 1. Left-click the PICTURE box at the left side of the screen to select the item to program. 2. Push the right button to show the PICTURE menu. [PICTURE MENU] 1 INT REJECT OFF/1/2/3 2 ECHO STRETCH OFF/1/2/3 3 ECHO AVERAGE OFF/1/2/3 4 NOISE REJ OFF/ON 5 AUTO STC OFF/ON 6 AUTO RAIN OFF/1/2/3/4 7 VIDEO CONTRAST 1/2/3/4/ A/B/C 8 [PULSE] 9 [CONDITION] 0 DEFAULT NO/SAVE/USER/ FACTORY PULSE menu 1-64 1. RADAR OPERATION 3. Set items 1-6 and 8 referring to the following sections: 1 INT REJECT: 1.25 5 AUTO STC: 1.17 2 ECHO STRETCH: 1.26 6 AUTO RAIN: 1.18 3 ECHO AVERAGE: 1.27 8 PULSE: 1.15 4 NOISE REJ: 1.28 4. Select 7 VIDEO CONTRAST. 5. Select 1, 2, 3 or 4 (Dynamic Range) or A, B, C (Curve) as appropriate. Refer to the description below and the illustration on the next page. 1-4: Control dynamic range. 1 provides the widest dynamic range; 4 is the narrowest dynamic range. A: Mid-level in the curve is low, so this setting is suitable for reducing rain clutter. B: Curve between A and C. C: Mid-level in the curve is high, so this setting is suitable for detecting distant targets. PICTURE level 5 db 7 db 9 db * Default 11 db VIDEO SIGNAL level Video contrast settings 6. Select 9 [CONDITION] then push the scrollwheel to show the CONDITION menu. [CONDITION MENU] 1 BACK 2 SEA CONDITION 1/2/3/4/5 3 ANT HEIGHT 5/7.5/10/15/20/ 25/30/35/40/45/ more50m 4 LOW LEVEL ECHO CONDITION menu 7. Select 2 SEA CONDITION. 8. Select appropriate sea condition. The larger the number the rougher the sea state. 1-65 1. RADAR OPERATION 9. Select 3 ANT HEIGHT. 10. Select appropriate radar antenna height (above the waterline). 11. If necessary, open the menu, select the ECHO menu and 9 STC RANGE to adjust effective STC range. The setting range is –10 to +10. The larger the number the longer the effective STC range becomes. Roll the scrollwheel to set. (Note that the keyboard cannot be used to enter the setting.) 12. If necessary Select 4 LOW LEVEL ECHO to reject low level echoes. The setting range is 0-8. The higher the figure the stronger the low level echo that is erased. 13. To save a program, Select 0 DEFAULT. 14. Select SAVE and push the scrollwheel or left button. 15. Push the right button twice to close the menu. Note: You may also program and save other picture setups. 1.35.3 Restoring user settings If you get lost in operation while adjusting the settings for a picture setup, you can easily restore user settings for that picture setup. Note that user settings are deleted when default settings are restored. 1. Left-click the PICTURE box at the left side of the screen to select the picture setup option for which you want to restore its user settings. 2. Push the right button to show the PICTURE menu. 3. Select 0 DEFAULT. 4. Select USER and push the left button or scrollwheel. 5. Push the right button to close the menu. 1.35.4 Restoring default picture setup options Any of the radar functions programmed with the picture setup options may be adjusted as desired. If you get lost in operation and want to restore the default settings for a particular picture setup operation, do the following: 1. Left-click the PICTURE box at the left side of the screen to select the picture setup option for which you want to restore its default settings. 2. Push the right button to show the PICTURE menu. 3. Select 0 DEFAULT. 4. Select FACTORY and push the left button or scrollwheel. 5. Push the right button to close the menu. 1-66 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.35.5 Disabling unnecessary picture setups There are quite a few picture setups from which to select, some which you may not require. You can disable unnecessary ones as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 1 [ECHO]. 3. Select 8 [PICTURE SELECT]. [PICTURE SELECT] 1 BACK 2 PICTURE SELECT PICTURE1 OFF/ON PICTURE2 OFF/ON PICTURE3 OFF/ON PICTURE4 OFF/ON NEAR OFF/ON FAR OFF/ON NEAR BUOY OFF/ON FAR BUOY OFF/ON ROUGH SEA OFF/ON SHIP OFF/ON HARBOR OFF/ON COAST OFF/ON 4. 5. 6. 7. Select 2 PICTURE SELECT. Select the picture setup you wish to disable and push the left button. Select OFF or ON as applicable and push the left button. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 1-67 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.36 Function Keys Less-often used functions are provided in the menu. To avoid opening the menus to set up the radar for a particular situation, function keys F1-F4 may be assigned any of the functions shown in the CUSTOMIZE•TEST sub menu. 1.36.1 Activating function keys To activate the function assigned to a function key, press the key to instantly set the radar for the preset purpose. Further press the key to select option. Function key F1 F2 F3 F4 1.36.2 Default setting Interference Rejector Echo Stretch Auto Rain Heading Line Off Programming function keys Do the following to program the function keys. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 9 [CUSTOMIZE•TEST] then push the scrollwheel. [CUSTOMIZE•TEST] BACK [DATA BOX] [F1] [F2] [F3] [F4] [OPERATION] [TEST] CUSTOMIZE•TEST menu 3. Select 3 [F1], 4 [F2], 5 [F3] or 6 [F4], whichever function key you want to set, For example, select 3 [F1] then push the left button. [F1] BACK [ECHO] [STD KEY] [TT•AIS] [OPERATION] [PICTURE] F1 menu 1-68 1. RADAR OPERATION 4. Select appropriate category, ECHO, STD KEY, TT•AIS, OPERATION or PICTURE. Refer to the menus below to select appropriate category. [ECHO] 1 BACK PICTURE/ IR ES/ EAV/ NOISE REJ/ ANT SELECT/ PULSE LENGTH/ A/C SEA SELECT/ AUTO RAIN SELECT/ TUNE SELECT/ ANT HEIGHT/ SEA CONDITION/ 2ND ECHO REJ/ PM/ SART WIPER [TT•AIS] 1 BACK DISP TT/ DISP AIS/ TARGET DATA & ACQ/ PAST POSN INTERVAL/ REF MARK/ CPA LIMIT/ CPA/ TCPA/ AZ1/ AZ2/ TARGET LIST SORT/ TRIAL MANEUVER/ ASSOCIATION/ AIS MESSAGE/ TRIAL MODE CHANGE AIS SCALED SYMBOL [PICTURE] 1 BACK PICTURE1/ PICTURE2/ PICTURE3/ PICTURE4/ NEAR/ FAR/ NEAR BUOY/ FAR BUOY/ ROUGH SEA/ SHIP/ HARBOR COAST [STD KEY] 1 BACK ALARM ACK/ STBY TX/ HL OFF/ EBL OFFSET/ MODE/ OFF CENTER/ CU TM RESET/ PI LINE/ VECTOR TIME/ VECTOR MODE/ TARGET LIST/ TRAIL/ BRILL/ MARK/ MENU/ RANGE UP/ RANGE DOWN/ ACQ/ TARGET DATA/ TARGET CANCEL [OPERATION] 1 BACK ECHO COLOR/ PALETTE/ RING/ ALARM1/ ALARM2/ WATCH ALARM RESET/ ZOOM/ MARK DELETE/ OWN TRACK DELETE/ TGT TRACK DELETE*/ CHART ALIGN/ DISPLAY SELECT/ RADAR COMBINE*/ MOB/ USER DEFAULT TLL*/ ANCHOR WATCH/ COLOR SHIFT/ ICON/ DISP*/ OWN TRK ALL ERASE TGT TRK ALL ERASE* MARK ALL ERASE DROP MARK * Not available on IMO type 1-69 1. RADAR OPERATION 5. Select "2". 6. Select function desired then push the scrollwheel or left button. 7. Push the right button twice to close the menu. Description of function key programs Item [ECHO] PICTURE IR ES EAV NOISE REJ ANT SELECT PULSE LENGTH A/C SEA SELECT AUTO RAIN SELECT TUNE SELECT ANT HEIGHT SEA CONDITION 2ND ECHO REJ PM SART WIPER [STD KEY] ALARM ACK STBY TX HL OFF EBL OFFSET OFF CENTER CU TM RESET PI LINE VECTOR TIME VECTOR MODE TARGET LIST TRAIL BRILL MARK MENU RANGE UP RANGE DOWN ACQ TARGET DATA TARGET CANCEL 1-70 Description Selects picture setup function. Selects interference rejection level. Selects echo stretch function. Selects echo averaging function. Turns noise rejector on/off. Selects antenna. Selects pulselength. Selects A/C SEA adjustment method. Selects AUTO RAIN level. Selects tuning adjustment method. Sets antenna height. Sets sea condition. Turns 2nd trace echo rejector on/off. Turns performance monitor on/off. Turns SART setup conditions on/off. Turns wiper (reduce weak and unwanted signals) on/off. Acknowledges alarm. (Silences audio alarm.) Toggles between stand-by and transmit. Turns heading line on/off. Offsets EBL. Off centers the display. Returns own ship mark to point 75% of range in use. Turns PI line on/off. Sets vector time. Sets vector mode. Displays target list. Sets trail parameters. Sets brilliance. Selects mark to inscribe. Opens the MAIN menu. Raises the range scale. Lowers the range scale. Acquires target; activates sleeping AIS target. Shows target data for selected tracked target or AIS target. Cancels tracking of tracked target; sleeps AIS target. 1. RADAR OPERATION Description of function key programs (con’t from previous page) Item [TT•AIS] DISP TT DISP AIS TARGET DATA & ACQ PAST POSN INTERVAL REF MARK CPA LIMIT CPA TCPA AZ1 AZ2 TARGET LIST SORT TRIAL MANEUVER ASSOCATION AIS MESSAGE TRIAL MODE CHANGE AIS SCALED SYMBOL [OPERATION] ECHO COLOR BACK COLOR RING ALARM1 ALARM2 WATCH ALARM RESET ZOOM MARK DELETE OWN TRACK DELETE TGT TRACK DELETE CHART ALIGN DISPLAY SELECT RADAR COMBINE* MOB USER DEFAULT TLL ANCHOR WATCH COLOR SHIFT ICON DISP Description Activates/deactivates TT. Activates/deactivates AIS. TT: Acquires target; shows data for tracked target selected. AIS: Activates sleeping AIS target; shows data for AIS target selected. Selects past position plotting interval. Inscribes reference mark (for target-based speed). Turns CPA limit on/off. Enters CPA range. Enters TCPA time. Sets Alarm Zone 1. Sets Alarm Zone 2. Sorts target list. Executes trial maneuver. Changes indication in Association Usage box. See 4.13. Displays AIS message board. Switches between dynamic and static modes. Scales AIS target symbols according to target (ship) size. Selects echo color. Selects background color. Turns range rings on/off. Sets no. 1 target alarm. Sets no. 2 target alarm. Resets watch alarm. Enables zoom. Deletes mark (origin mark, waypoint mark, plotter mark). Deletes own ship’s tracks according to setting of OWN TRACK menu (see page 5-15). Deletes other ship’s tracks according to setting of TARGET TRACK menu (see page 5-15). Aligns chart with radar picture. Selects display mode. Dual-radar display. *Non-IMO only Inscribes MOB mark. Restores user defaults for [F1]-[F3]. For F-KEY: 1. Set equipment as desired. 2. Long-push (more then 1 s) function key registered as USER DEFAULT. 3. To recall a setting, do step 2. The radar is then set to stand-by and "USER DEFAULT" appears at the bottom-right corner. For STORE: 1. Set equipment as desired. 2. Select STORE at 2 USER DEFAULT BACKUP from page (2/2) of the OPERATION menu. Select HOLD to register settings. 3. To recall setting, press the function key registered as USER DEFAULT. The radar is then set to stand-by and "USER DEFAULT" appears at the bottom-right corner. Target latitude and longitude output (to chart plotter). Enables the anchor watch alarm. Paint own ship's tracks in different colors. Hides and shows boxes outside the effective display area. 1-71 1. RADAR OPERATION Item Description [OPERATION] (con't from previous page) OWN TRK ALL ERASE Erases all own ship’s tracks. TGT TRK ALL ERASE Erases all other ship’s tracks. MARK ALL ERASE Erases all marks. DROP MARK Inscribe a drop mark. [PICTURE] PICTURE1 – PICTURE4 Actuates settings of user-programmed setup. NEAR Optimum setting for short range detection using a range scale of 3 nm or less on calm seas FAR Optimum setting for long range detection using a range scale of 6 nm or larger NEAR BUOY Optimum setting for detecting navigation buoys, small vessels and other small surface objects at close range FAR BUOY Optimum setting for detecting navigation buoys, small vessels and other small surface objects at long range ROUGH SEA Optimum setting for rough weather or heavy rain SHIP Optimum setting for detecting vessels HARBOR Optimum setting for harbor navigation COAST Optimum setting for coastal navigation 1.37 Ship’s Position Select the source of ship’s position data as follows: 1. Right-click the OSN POSN box at the top right corner of the screen to show the OS POSN menu. [OS POSN MENU] 1 NAV AID GPS1/GPS2/ DEAD RECKONING/ LAN 2 MANUAL L/L 00°00.00 N 000°00.00 W 3 SIO DATA LAN OUTPUT OFF/ON OS POSN menu 2. Select 1 NAV AID. 3. Select GPS1, GPS2 or DEAD RECKONING as appropriate. GPS1: GPS navigator connected to nav port GPS2: GPS navigator connected to SPEED LOG port or TRACK CONTROL port. 1-72 1. RADAR OPERATION 4. If you have selected DEAD RECKONING do the following to enter position manually. For GPS1 or GPS2, go to step 6. a) Select 2 MANUAL L/L then push the scrollwheel. Enter latitude and longitude position as follows. b) Roll the scrollwheel to set appropriate digit in the latitude field then push the scrollwheel. (You may push the scrollwheel again to skip a place.) For keyboard operation, press appropriate numeric keys then press the [ENTER MARK] key. c) Set longitude similar to how you set latitude then push the scrollwheel. (For keyboard operation, press the [ENTER MARK] key.) Note: Co-ordinate polarity may be switched by rolling the scrollwheel, or pressing the [2] key. 5. To use a navigation device connected to radars via a LAN, set 3 SIO DATA LAN OUTPUT to ON, then select LAN at 1 NAV AID. 6. Push the right button to close the menu. Note: When the AIS function is active, DEAD RECKONING is shown in gray to indicate that it is not available for selection. 1-73 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.38 Second-trace Echoes In certain situations, echoes from very distance targets may appear as false echoes (second-trace echoes) on the screen. This occurs when the return echo is received one transmission cycle later, or after a next radar pulse has been transmitted. Tx repetition Second-trace echo False echo range Actual range Second-trace echoes To reject second-trace echoes: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 1 [ECHO] to open the ECHO menu. [ECHO] 1 BACK ND 2 2 ECHO REJ OFF/ON 3 TUNE INITIALIZE 4 PM OFF/ON 5 SART OFF/ON 6 WIPER OFF/1/2 7 ECHO AREA*1 CIRCLE/WIDE/ALL 8 [PICTURE SELECT] *1 Not available on IMO or A type 9 STC RANGE +00 ECHO menu ND 3. Select 2 2 ECHO REJ. 4. Select OFF or ON as appropriate. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 1-74 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.39 Brilliance of Screen Data You can adjust relative brilliance levels of various markers and alphanumeric readouts displayed on the screen. 1. Right-click the BRILL box at the bottom left corner of the screen to show the BRILL menu. [BRILL1 MENU (1/2)] 1 ECHO COLOR YEL/GRN/ WHT/COLOR* 2 PALETTE DAY-GRY/DAY-BLU/ DUSK-GRY/DUSK-BLU/ NIGHT-GRY/NIGHT-BLU/ 3 PANEL DIMMER 4 CHARACTER 5 CURSOR 6 ECHO 7 TRAIL 8 HL 9 RING 0 NEXT * Not available on IMO or A type Choose 0 NEXT to show page 2 of the BRILL menu. [BRILL1 MENU (2/2)] BACK BRG CURSOR EBL VRM PI LINE TT SYMBOL AIS SYMBOL L/L GRID MARK CHART* Note: Four brilliance and color sets are provided. For further details see section 1.49. BRILL menu 2. Select item you wish to adjust. (To go to the second page of the BRILL menu select 0 NEXT and push the scrollwheel.) Page 1 Page 2 Adjusts Item Adjusts brilliance of; brilliance of; 1 ECHO COLOR See section 1.49. 2 BRG CURSOR Bearing cursor 2 PALETTE See section 1.49. 3 EBL EBLs 3 PANEL Backlighting of 4 VRM VRMs DIMMER control unit 4 CHARACTER All alphanumeric 5 PI LINE PI lines characters 5 CURSOR Cursor (+) and 6 TT SYMBOL TT symbols arrow 6 ECHO Radar echoes 7 AIS SYMBOL AIS symbols 7 TRAIL Target trails 8 L/L Chart grid 8 HL Heading line 9 MARK All marks 9 RING Range rings 0 CHART Chart 3. Roll the scrollwheel to set brilliance level. The range of adjustment for items except "HL" and "CURSOR" is 0-100%. The range of adjustment for HL and CURSOR is 50-100%. 4. Push the right button once or twice to close the menu. Item 1-75 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.40 Watch Alarm The watch alarm sounds the audio alarm at the selected time interval to help you keep regular watch of the radar picture for safety or other purposes. The WATCH box appears at right side of the screen with a watch alarm timer counts down from value set (for example, "12:00"). WATCH 12:00 WATCH box When a preset time interval has elapsed, the audible watch alarm is released, the screen label WATCH turns red and the watch alarm timer freezes at "0:00." To silence the alarm, press the [ALARM ACK] key on the full keyboard or left-click the ALARM ACK box. The label WATCH turns to normal color and the watch alarm timer is reset to the initial value and starts the count-down sequence again. If you press the [ALARM ACK] key or click the box with the left button before the selected time interval is reached, the watch alarm timer is reset to the initial value and starts the count-down sequence again. To set watch time interval: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 3 [ALARM] to open the ALARM menu. [ALARM] 1 BACK 2 TARGET ALARM MODE IN/OUT 3 TARGET ALARM MODE 1/2/3/4 4 WATCH ALARM OFF/6M/10M/ 12M/15M/20M 5 ALARM SOUND LEVEL OFF/LOW/MID/HIGH 6 [ALARM OUT1] 7 [ALARM OUT2] 8 [ALARM OUT3] 9 [ALARM OUT4] 0 [PRIMARY ALARM] ALARM menu 3. Select 4 WATCH ALARM. 4. Select appropriate time interval then push the right button twice to close the menu. 1-76 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.41 Nav Data Wind, depth, ocean current, water temperature, date and time and waypoint data may be set up as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 7 [NAV DATA]. [NAV DATA] 1 BACK 2 DEPTH OFF/m/ft 3 DEPTH GRAPH SCALE 10/20/50/ 100/200/500 4 DEPTH MARK 000 5 CURRENT OFF/ON 6 WIND OFF/m/s/kn RELATIVE/ TRUE THEORETICAL/ TRUE NORTH 7 TEMP OFF/ON 8 DATE-TIME OFF/UTC/LOCAL 9 LOCAL TIME ADJ +00:00 0 WPT DATA OFF/REL/TRUE NAV DATA menu 3. Select appropriate options referring to the table on the next page for details. 1-77 1. RADAR OPERATION Nav data menu description Item Description 2 DEPTH Selects unit of depth measurement, or turn depth indication off. 3 DEPTH GRAPH SCALE Selects depth scale range. The echogram shows the last 30 minutes of sounding along the ship’s track. 4 DEPTH MARK Selects the depth at which to show the depth mark. 5 CURRENT Turns ocean current display on (ocean current relative to North) or off. 6 WIND Selects unit of wind speed measurement/wind speed format. Wind vector format can be selected from three choices: RELATIVE: Apparent wind measured by wind meter, with ship's bow as reference. TRUE THEORETICAL: Apparent wind minus ship's movement, with ship's bow as reference. TRUE NORTH: Apparent wind minus ship's movement, with North as reference. 7 TEMP Turns water temperature indication on/off. 8 DATE-TIME Selects how to display date and time: OFF, UTC or LOCAL. 9 LOCAL TIME ADJ If LOCAL is selected at 8 DATE-TIME, roll the scrollwheel to set the time difference between local time and UTC time. A negative value may be selected by spinning the scrollwheel past zero. 0 WPT DATA Turn waypoint data off or select waypoint data reference, true or relative. 4. Push the right button twice to close the menu. Note: Wind and current data require appropriate sensors. Depth data requires appropriate echo-sounding equipment. Wind vector shows a direction from which the wind blows in, relative to own ship heading, and labeled "T *." Wind velocity is a true wind speed as a result of compensating for own ship’s speed and orientation. Ocean current (tide) is shown relative to bow in head-up, cursor gyro and course-up, and reference to North in north-up and true motion. Present depth Current relative to north, full scale 10 kn. 20 40 60 Last 30 minutes of depth 30 20 Wind direction indication method depends on the MENU Selection of Wind Vector. 80 100 m 10 min Echogram OS heading Wind, current graph Examples of depth echogram and wind, tide graph 1-78 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.42 Text Window The text window, displayed at the right 1/4 of the screen, mainly shows nav data, zoomed target, and tracked target data. You can set up this window as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 9 [CUSTOMIZE•TEST] [CUSTOMIZE•TEST] BACK [DATA BOX] [F1] [F2] [F3] [F4] [OPERATION] [TEST] CUSTOMIZE•TEST menu 3. Select 2 [DATA BOX]. [DATA BOX] 1 BACK 3 NAV DATA OFF/ON 4 ZOOM OFF/2TIMES/3TIMES 5 ZOOM DISPLAY STAB GND/STAB HGD/ STAB NORTH/ TT TRACK 6 TARGET DATA 1BOX/2BOX/3BOX/ LARGE DATA BOX menu 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Select 3 NAV DATA. Select OFF or ON as appropriate. Select 4 ZOOM. Select OFF or zoom magnification factor (2TIMES or 3 TIMES). If you selected a zoom factor at step 7, go to step 9. Otherwise, go to step 11. 9. Select 5 ZOOM DISPLAY. 1-79 1. RADAR OPERATION 10. Select zoom display format. STAB GND: Ground stabilized (geographically Fixed) STAB HDG: Heading stabilized (relative) STAB NORTH: North stabilized (true) TT TRACK: Zoom tracked targets. 11. Select 6 TARGET DATA. 12. Select quantity of tracked target data to show among 1BOX, 2BOX, 3BOX and LARGE. Note: Nav data or zoom is automatically removed when "3BOX" is selected. Nav Data or Zoom Nav Data or Zoom Zoom 2 BOX 1 BOX 1 BOX TT, AIS Functions Box TT, AIS Functions Box Warnings, Alerts Warnings, Alerts Guidance Box Guidance Box 1 BOX 2 BOX 3 BOX Nav Data or Zoom 2 BOX LARGE 1 BOX TT, AIS Functions Box TT, AIS Functions Box Warnings, Alerts Warnings, Alerts Guidance Box Guidance Box 3 BOX LARGE Tracked data setting and data box arrangement 13. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 1-80 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.43 Customizing Operation Several operation items may be customized to suit your needs. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 9 [CUSTOMIZE•TEST] to open the CUSTOMIZE•TEST menu. [CUSTOMIZE•TEST] BACK [DATA BOX] [F1] [F2] [F3] [F4] [OPERATION] [TEST] CUSTOMIZE•TEST menu 3. Select 7 [OPERATION]. [OPERATION] 1 BACK 2 WHEEL DRIVE NORMAL/REVERSE 3 KEY BEEP OFF/LO/MID/HI 4 REMOTE KEY F*-KEY/ DISPLAY SELECT 5 POP UP GUIDANCE* OFF/ON 6 OWN SHIP VECTOR OFF/HDG/COURSE 7 STERN-UP OFF/ON 8 SHUTTLE FERRY OFF/MODE1/MODE2 * Not available on IMO or A type 0 NEXT OPERATION menu 4. Set each item as appropriate, referring to the table on the next page for details. 5. Push the right button to close the menu. 1-81 1. RADAR OPERATION Operation menu items 1-82 Item No. 2 WHEEL DRIVE Description Select how to cycle data when using the scrollwheel. 3 KEY BEEP Key beeps when key sequence has been correctly executed. 4 REMOTE KEY Select function of keys F1-F4 on control unit. 5 POP UP GUIDANCE (Available on B, C and W types) 6 OWN SHIP VECTOR Pop up guidance 7 STERN-UP Enables/disables the stern-up presentation mode. 8 SHUTTLE FERRY Turns shuttle ferry mode on or off. Select what the own ship vector displays. Options NORMAL: Cycles numeral data in numeric order and indication data in clockwise order. REVERSE: Reverse of NORMAL. OFF: No key beep LO, MID, HI: Loudness of key beep F*-KEY: Operates as function key. DISPLAY: Control unit operates radar it is connected to. You may turn the guidance off or on. OFF: No own ship vector HDG: Vector shows heading direction. COURSE: Vector shows course. ON: Enables stern-up mode. OFF: Disables stern-up mode. OFF: Disables shuttle ferry mode. MODE1: Head-up picture is rotated 180°. MODE2: Head-up picture is rotated 180° and the gyro reading has 180° added to it or subtracted from it. 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.44 Alert Box When error or alarm setting violation is found, the applicable indication appears (red, flashing) in the Alert Box and the buzzer sounds. The Alert Box is composed of four lines of information, as shown below. Silence the buzzer with the [ALARM ACK] key or select the ALARM ACK box then push the left button. The buzzer and the flashing stop but the alarm indication remains on the display until the reason for the alarm is removed. Alert Box Configuration (lines inside box not present in actual box) Line 1: Name of ERROR or ALARM category Line 2: Name of error or alarm Line 3: Message Category WARNING Line 4: Name of warning Display Example 1: ERROR and WARNING - - - - - SYSTEM ERROR - - - - VIDEO - - - - - - WARNING - - - - - FORMAT CARD DATA Display Example 2: ERROR only - - - - AIS ALARM MESSAGE - - - AIS: no valid ROT info rmation Display Example 3: ERROR and WARNING - - - - AIS ALARM MESSAGE - - - AIS: no valid ROT info - - - - - - WARNING - - - - - RD CARD DATA 1-83 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.44.1 Alarm description Alarm description Alarm name (visual indication) Visual alarm, reason To quit alarm status SYSTEM ERROR AZIMUTH No antenna rotation signal HEADLINE No heading signal KEY No key signal RF No RF communications signal TRIGGER No trigger signal TT SYSTEM ERROR TT system malfunction VIDEO No video signal Acknowledge indication by pressing the [ALARM ACK] key or left-clicking the ALARM ACK box. Restore signal or remove reason for to remove indication. SENSOR ERROR GYRO The indication "GYRO" (in red) appears and the HDG indication reads "***.*°". The orientation mode is automatically set for head-up. TT, radar map, AIS, and echo averaging are disabled. Match the on-screen HDG indication with the actual compass. The indication "HEADING SET" appears. Press the [ALARM ACK] key to erase the indication. LOG The indication "LOG" (in red) appears and the and the speed indication shows "**.* kn" if the speed signal is lost more than 30 s. For BT error, CPA and TCPA for AIS are not calculated. If the SDME has failed, use another speed sensor. EPFS The indication "EPFS" (in red) appears and the position display shows all asterisks if the position input is lost more than 30 s. Radar map, AIS, and echo averaging are disabled. Acknowledge indication by pressing the [ALARM ACK] key or left-clicking the ALARM ACK box. Restore signal to remove indication. Message cannot be erased if position signal is missing; it is automatically erased when the signal is restored. DATUM For the IMO type, the indication "DATUM" (in red) appears if the datum is other than WGS-84 or WGS-84 is not input. AIS is inoperative with datum other than WGS-84. Acknowledge indication by pressing the [ALARM ACK] key or left-clicking the ALARM ACK box. Use WGS-84 datum. 1-84 1. RADAR OPERATION Alarm name (visual indication) Visual alarm, reason To quit alarm status AIS ALARM (See section 4.15.) DUAL RADAR ALARM (Non-IMO only) EXT RADAR STBY External radar is in standby Set external radar in transmit to erase indication. EXT RADAR ERROR External radar malfunction Restore external radar to normal condition to erase indication. EXT RADAR HDG SET Problem with heading data at external radar. Re-set external radar's heading data to erase indication. ANCHOR WATCH Ship has drifted more than a threshold value. Acknowledge indication by pressing the [ALARM ACK] key or left-clicking the ALARM ACK box. ARRIVAL Own ship has arrived to a waypoint. Acknowledge indication by pressing the [ALARM ACK] key or left-clicking the ALARM ACK box. CHECK INT-SW Interswitch malfunction Acknowledge indication by pressing the [ALARM ACK] key or left-clicking the ALARM ACK box. Check interswitch. DEPTH Depth is lower or higher than threshold value. Acknowledge indication by pressing the [ALARM ACK] key or left-clicking the ALARM ACK box. HEADING SET Heading signal has been restored. Press the [ALARM ACK] key to erase the message. Match the on-screen HDG readout with the actual compass reading, if necessary. MEMORY CARD FULL Memory card is full Acknowledge indication by pressing the [ALARM ACK] key or left-clicking the ALARM ACK box. TARGET ALARM A target has entered (or exited) the target alarm zone. Target flashes. Acknowledge indication by pressing the [ALARM ACK] key or left-clicking the ALARM ACK box. WATCH WATCH 0:00 Press the [ALARM ACK] key or click the WATCH box with the left button. The WATCH box is displayed in normal video and the timer is reset. OTHER ALARM (WATCH appears and time count freezes at 0:00). XTE Own ship is off course more than threshold value. Acknowledge indication by pressing the [ALARM ACK] key or left-clicking the ALARM ACK box. 1-85 1. RADAR OPERATION Alarm name (visual indication) Visual alarm, reason To quit alarm status TT ALARM (See section 3.15.) WARNING AIS TRANSMITTING AIS transponder is transmitting. CABLE ATT ADJ Adjustment (at installation) according to length of antenna cable. DELETE CARD DATA Deleting data from memory card. FORMAT CARD DATA Formatting memory card. PM Performance monitor active POWER RESTART Loading installation settings from memory card. RD CARD DATA Reading from memory card. SART Radar set up to receive SART. TUNE INITIALIZE Initializing tuning. USER DEFAULT Restoring user defaults. WR CARD DATA Writing to memory card. Indication disappears when procedure is completed. Note 1: It is not possible to acknowledge the radar critical alarms from external equipment without displaying the reason/cause for the alarm. Radar critical alarms are TT COLLISION and AIS COLLISION. Note 2: This radar does not receive alarm information from external alarm systems. 1-86 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.44.2 Alarm list The alarm list displays the names of violated alarms, including the time and date violated. A maximum of 28 alarms are shown, on four pages. Unacknowledged alarms are displayed first in the list (in red text), in the order in which they appear in the Alert Box. An unacknowledged alarm can be acknowledged from the list by selecting its number and hitting the left button. To erase the data for the number selected, hit the left button again. To erase all alarm indications, select 9 REFRESH DATA and long-push the left button. To display the alarm list, put the cursor in the Alert Box and push the right button. [ALARM LIST (1/1)] 1 BACK (L=TOP) 2 - - - SENSOR ERROR - - EPFS 03/APR/2008 09:34 3 - - - AIS ALARM - - AIS NEW TARGET 03/APR/2008 08:02 4 - - - SENSOR ERROR - - LOG 03/APR/2008 07:18 5 - - - PRIMARY ALARM - - TT COLLISION 03/APR/2008 06:50 6 - - - - TT ALARM - - - TT LOST 03/APR/2008 06:43 7 - - - OTHER ALARM - - DEPTH 02/APR/2008 23:53 8 - - - OTHER ALARM - - WATCH 02/APR/2008 20:00 9 REFRESH DATA (L=CLR) 0 NEXT Alarm category* Alarm name Date and time of violation * AIS ALARM DUAL RADAR ALARM OTHER ALARM PRIMARY ALARM SENSOR ERROR SYSTEM ERROR TT ALARM • When there is more than one alarm page you can switch between them with 0 NEXT and 0 BACK (last page). • ZDA sentence required in order to display time in Alarm list. 1-87 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.44.3 Outputting alarm signals Four ports are provided from which to output alarm signals to external equipment. Select the port and alarm signals to output as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 3 [ALARM]. ALARM menu 3. Select appropriate "ALARM OUT" item (6-9). ALARM OUT1, 2: Normally closed ALARM OUT3, 4: Normally open 4. Select an alarm to output. The alarm selected is underlined. 5. Repeat step 5 to select other alarms to output. 6. Push the right button three times to close the menu. [ALARM] 1 BACK 2 GUARD ALARM MODE IN/OUT 3 GUARD ALARM LEVEL 1/2/3/4 4 WATCH ALARM OFF/6M/10M/ 12M/15/20M 5 ALARM SOUND LEVEL OFF/LOW/MID/HIGH 6 [ALARM OUT1] 7 [ALARM OUT2] 8 [ALARM OUT3] 9 [ALARM OUT4] 0 [PRIMARY ALARM] [ALARM OUT1] 1 BACK TARGET ALARM WATCH ALARM TT NEW TARGET TT LOST TARGET TT CPA LIMIT TT AUTO ACQ TGT FULL TT MAN ACQ TGT FULL TT SYSTEM ERROR AIS NEW TARGET AIS LOST TARGET AIS CPA LIMIT AIS TGT FULL AZIMUTH HEAD LINE TRIGGER VIDEO GYRO LOG EPFS XTE ARRIVAL WPT DEPTH ALARM ACK OUT OPERATOR FITNESS ANCHOR WATCH NO CPA/TCPA FOR AIS 9 ALARM OUT POLARITY NORMAL/INVERT ALARM OUT1 menu 1-88 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.44.4 Primary alarm Violated alarms appear in the Alert Box in the order of priority shown in the table below. Priority Alarm group Alarms Error (sensor and system) Azimuth, Datum EPFS, Gyro, Headline, Key, Log, RF, Trigger, TT System Error, Video Primary See the PRIMARY ALARM menu below. TT CPA LIMIT and NO CPA/TCPA FOR AIS are ON in default. Other alarms Any alarm not listed here. If desired you can assign primary alarms the same priority as Error alarms. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 3 [ALARM]. 3. Select 0 [PRIMARY ALARM]. [PRIMARY ALARM] 1 BACK TARGET ALARM WATCH ALARM TT NEW TARGET TT LOST TARGET TT AUTO ACQ TGT FULL TT MAN ACQ TGT FULL AIS NEW TARGET AIS LOST TARGET AIS TGT FULL XTE ARRIVAL WPT DEPTH ANCHOR WATCH NO CPA/TCPA FOR AIS PRIMARY ALARM menu 4. Select alarm(s) for which you want to give priority equal to that of Error alarms. Selected alarms are underlined. 5. Press the right button several times to close the menu. 1-89 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.45 Interswitch The interswitch of this radar uses an Ethernet to transfer video and control signals. A digital signal transfers the video and control signals. You can connect four antennas and eight display units. Set radar display and antenna groups from the ANTENNA SELECT display. When you switch to a different antenna, the heading skew and timing adjustment (set at installation) for that antenna is automatically applied. The ANTENNA box at the upper left position shows current antenna selection. NM /1 HEAD UP TB RM DISPLAY RADAR ANT1M X-BAND ANTENNA Box PULSE S1 - ANT1: Antenna no. - M: Master (or S for Slave) PICTURE4 - X-band (or S-band) 1.45.1 Displaying antenna information The ANTENNA SELECT display shows: • Radar band, output power and antenna position of each antenna currently powered. (If an antenna is not powered, its data area is blank.) • Current antenna and display combinations. • Your radar number To show the ANTENNA SELECT display, right-click the ANTENNA. [ANT SELECT] Antenna no. Output power (kW) ANT1: X-BAND 12 FORE ANT2: X-BAND 12 MAIN TOP ANT3: X-BAND 12 MAIN TOP ANT4: X-BAND 12 AFT OWN RADAR No.: 2 1 DISP1 Current display and antenna combinations ANT1 MASTER 2 DISP2 ANT2 MASTER 3 DISP3 ANT3 MASTER 4 DISP4 ANT4 MASTER 9 STORE INTER-SW NO/YES 0 SUB MONITOR* OFF/ON * Not available on IMO or A radar. 1-90 Radar band (X or S) Radar antenna position (set at installation) (FORE, MAIN TOP,MAIN 2ND, MAIN 3RD, AFT, PORT, STARBOARD) Own radar no. Using the information displayed in this example, the antenna system configuration would look like this. ANT1 ANT2 ANT3 ANT4 DISP1 DISP2 DISP3 DISP4 HUB 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.45.2 Presetting antenna and display combinations You can preset the antenna and display combinations for each antenna and display in the radar system. As an example, the procedure below shows how to select the no. 1 antenna unit for the no. 2 display unit. 1. Right-click the ANTENNA box to show the ANT SELECT display. [ANT SELECT] ANT1: X-BAND 12 FORE ANT2: X-BAND 12 MAIN TOP ANT3: X-BAND 12 MAIN TOP ANT4: X-BAND 12 AFT OWN RADAR No.: 2 1 DISP1 ANT1 MASTER 2 DISP2 ANT2 MASTER 3 DISP3 ANT3 MASTER 4 DISP4 ANT4 MASTER 9 STORE INTER-SW NO/YES 0 SUB MONITOR* OFF/ON * Not available on IMO or A radar. 2. Select the display unit for which to select an antenna (at the next step). For example, select 2 DISP2 to select the no. 2 display unit. 3. The cursor is now selecting the current display and antenna combination for the no. 2 display unit. Roll the scrollwheel to display ANT1 MASTER and push the left button. 4. Repeat step 3 and 4 to set other display and antenna combinations. 5. Select 0 STORE INTER-SW. 6. Select YES to save display and antenna combinations. 7. Push the right button twice to close the menu. Selection considerations • A antenna unit cannot be controlled from multiple display units. Select one MASTER display unit for one antenna unit. If two antenna units are set as masters, the display last-set as master becomes the master and all other displays are automatically changed to slave. • An antenna unit without a MASTER display cannot be selected on the sub display units. If there is no antenna unit set as master, the lowest number display is automatically set as master. 1-91 1. RADAR OPERATION • Radar functions are controlled independently, dependently or commonly depending on selection as Master or Slave. RADAR FUNCTIONS CONTROL MASTER DISPLAY OPTION SLAVE DISPLAY OPTION AIS function Brilliance Echo stretch Echo averaging Echo trails EBL Lat/long data Presentation mode Speed data Target alarm TT, AIS on/off TT, AIS track interval Vector mode Vector time Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Independent Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set (Echo Sampling at Master Range) Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set A/C SEA A/C RAIN Auto Rain Gain IR Picture setting STBY/TX Tuning Reference point Dependent Control Dependent Control Dependent Control Dependent Control Dependent Control Dependent Control Dependent Control Dependent Control Dependent Control Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Desired Value Can be set Cannot control Cannot control Cannot control Cannot control Cannot control Cannot control Cannot control Cannot control Cannot control TT LOST alarm TT COLLISION alarm TT alarms ACK TT acquire TT/AIS AZ Common Control Common Control Common Control Common Control Common Control Item Commonly Controlled Item Commonly Controlled Item Commonly Controlled Item Commonly Controlled Item Commonly Controlled Item Commonly Controlled Item Commonly Controlled Item Commonly Controlled Item Commonly Controlled Item Commonly Controlled VRM Wiper Zoom Range (Sampling at Master) • If the message "CHECK INT-SW" appears, do one of the following as applicable: - If only your antenna is not displayed on the ANTENNA SELECT display, LAN line in your processor may be faulty. In this case, use the standalone mode. - If the antenna that was in use does not appear on the ANTENNA SELECT display, LAN line in other processor unit may be faulty. In this case, see page 1-91 for how to select a different antenna unit. • When the Network fails, the Interswitch does not work, but standalone operation is possible. • With the dual radar display active, antenna and display can be selected from the initial settings screen. 1-92 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.45.3 Selecting an antenna For the ship that carries multiple antennas, you may choose the antenna to use as follows: 1. Roll the trackball to place the arrow in the ANTENNA box at the left side of the screen. ANT1 X-BAND (M) 2. Roll the scrollwheel to choose an antenna then push the left button. 1.46 Cursor Data Cursor data can be shown in latitude and longitude position or cursor’s X-Y coordinates, with the C specification radar. Left-click the CURSOR DATA box at the right side of the display to select the cursor data to show. The cursor data changes in the sequence shown below. 34°40.849 N + 135°18.303 E CURSOR DATA box (L/L position) 34°30.323 N Latitude and longitude + 135°08.263 E position of cursor 9.649NM 9.683NM Cursor X-Y position Cursor data options Note 1: For the X-Y coordinates display, the Y-axis is the heading line, right/top is "plus" and left/lower is "minus." Note 2: When displaying latitude and longitude position and the cursor has been aligned (on the PLOTTER menu), the indication "CHART ALIGN" appears at the right side of the screen (in red). Note 3: Cursor data reads "- - -.-" when the cursor is placed outside the effective display area. Note 4: Cursor bearing format (true or relative) and cursor range unit (nm, sm, km or kyd) are available as below. Type IMO Cursor bearing format Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Cursor range unit No No Yes Yes No Menu operation 2 [MARK]→9 EBL CURSOR BEARING 2 [MARK] →9 [EBL, VRM CURSOR SET] →CURSOR BEARING, CURSOR RANGE 1-93 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.47 Performance Monitor A performance monitor is required for a radar installed on vessels of 300 GT and upward engaged in international voyages. Two units are available: X-band radar: PM-31 (9410 ± 45 MHz) S-band radar: PM-51 (3050 ± 30 MHz). The performance monitor is incorporated in the antenna unit. When the performance monitor is active, the indication "PM" appears (in yellow) in the alarm box. 1.47.1 Activating, deactivating the performance monitor 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 1 [ECHO] to open the ECHO menu. [ECHO] 1 BACK ND 2 2 ECHO REJ OFF/ON 3 TUNE INITIALIZE 4 PM OFF/ON 5 SART OFF/ON 6 WIPER OFF/1/2 7 ECHO AREA*1 CIRCLE/WIDE/ALL 8 [PICTURE SELECT] *1 Not available on IMO or A type 9 STC RANGE +00 ECHO menu 3. Select 4 PM. 4. Select OFF or ON as appropriate. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. "PM" appears on the display when the performance monitor is active. 1.47.2 Checking radar performance 1. The radar is automatically set up as follows: Range: 24 nm Pulselength: Long Shadow Sector: Off A/C SEA: Off A/C RAIN: Off Echo Stretch: Off Echo Average: Off Interference Rej.: Off Video Contrast: 4-B Tune: Auto Gain: Initial setting (as set with PM GAIN ADJ at installation) 1-94 1. RADAR OPERATION 2. Turn on the performance monitor referring to section 1.47.1. 3. After observing the results turn off the performance monitor. The range scale is automatically set to 24 nm. The radar screen will show one or two arcs. If the radar transmitter and receiver are in good working conditions in as much as the original state when the monitor was turned up, the innermost arcs should appear between 13.5 to 18.5 nm. The performance monitor can observe a total of 10 dB loss in transmitter and receiver. Display Radar State Transmitter: normal Receiver: normal 13.5 nm to 18.5 nm 13.5 nm to 18.5 nm Transmitter and receiver: No arc is indication of10 db loss. Replacement of the magnetron is necessary. Note: The lengths of the arcs may vary according to installation environment. Judge the strength of the echo that appears within 90° behind own ship to confirm if the radar is working properly or not. 1-95 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.48 Own Ship Marker Own ship marker ( ) may be inscribed on the screen as below. You may enter ten such symbols. Each own ship symbols is shown with a number. 1. Use the trackball to select the MARK box at the left side of the screen. The guidance box now reads "MARK SELECT / MARK MENU." MARK Mark type last selected, mark number -> + - - -m, - - -m Dimensions of own ship Mark box 2. Push the right button to open the MARK menu. [MARK MENU] 1 ORIGIN MARK STAB GND/SEA 2 MARK KIND ORIGIN MARK(No. )/ ORIGIN MARK(SYM)/ MAP MARK/ WP 1~50/ WP 51~ 100/ WP 101~150/ WP 151~198/ OWN SHIP SHAPE 8 MARK POSN CURSOR/OS/L/L 00°000.00 N 000°000.00 E 9 MAP DISPLAY OFF/ON 0 MAP MARK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT * Not available on IMO or A type MARK menu 3. Select "2". 4. Select OWN SHIP SHAPE. (On the W-type, the indication "OS" appears to the right of the MARK box.) 5. Push the right button to close the menu. 6. Use the trackball to select the own ship symbol at the bottom left corner. 7. Roll the scrollwheel to select the point number for which you want to change its position. See figure at right. 8. Push the left button. The cursor positions at the point number selected. 9. Use the trackball to drag the point to location desired. 10. Push the left button to confirm selected location. 11. Repeat steps 6-10 continue changing symbol shape. 1-96 10 09 01 08 07 02 03 04 06 05 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.49 Color and Brilliance Sets This radar provides six sets of color and brilliance sets to match any ambient lighting condition. 1.49.1 Selecting color and brilliance set Left-click the BRILL box at the left side of the screen to select color and brilliance set from among BRILL1 – BRILL4. The default specifications of each brilliance set are is in the table below. PALETTE DAY-GRY DAY-BLU DUSK-GRY DUSK-BLU NIGHT-GRY NIGHT-BLU 1.49.2 BRILL 100 100 20 20 PANEL 15 15 10 10 OTHERS 15 15 15 15 15 15 TEXT COLOR GREEN WHITE GREEN WHITE RED WHITE BKGD/CIRCLE GRY/BLK BLU/BLU GRY/BLU BLU/BLU GRY/BLK BRT-BLU/BRT-BLU Presetting color and brilliance set 1. Right-click the BRILL box at the left side of the screen to open the BRILL menu. [BRILL1 MENU (1/2)] 1 ECHO COLOR YEL/GRN/ WHT/COLOR* 2 PALETTE DAY-GRY/DAY-BLU/ DUSK-GRY/DUSK-BLU/ NIGHT-GRY/NIGHT-BLU/ 3 PANEL DIMMER 4 CHARACTER 5 CURSOR 6 ECHO 7 TRAIL 8 HL 9 RING 0 NEXT * Not available on IMO or A type BRILL menu 2. Select 1 ECHO COLOR. 3. Select echo color desired. "COLOR," available on the B, C and W types, displays echoes in colors of red, yellow and green, corresponding to signal levels of strong, medium and weak. 1-97 1. RADAR OPERATION 4. Select 2 PALETTE. 5. Select desired time of day and background color combination. PALETTE DAY-GRY DAY-BLU DUSK-GRY DUSK-BLU NIGHT-GRY NIGHT-BLU BRILL 100 100 20 20 PANEL 15 15 10 10 OTHERS 15 15 15 15 15 15 TEXT COLOR GREEN WHITE GREEN WHITE RED WHITE BKGD/CIRCLE GRY/BLK BLU/BLU GRY/BLU BLU/BLU GRY/BLK BRT-BLU/BRT-BLU 6. Set brilliance-related items referring to section 1.39. 7. Push the right button to close the BRILL menu. Note: The above default settings are restored whenever the setting for 2 PALETTE is changed. 1-98 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.50 Reference Position The reference position for measurements (range, bearing, etc.) and markers (heading line, stern mark, etc.) can be antenna position or consistent common reference point (CCRP), which is a location on own ship to which all horizontal measurements, for example range, bearing, relative course, relative speed, closest point of approach (CPA) or time to closest point of approach (TCPA), are normally referenced. To select reference position, right-click the REF POINT indication at the top of the screen to select ANT or CCRP as applicable. The position of the own ship marker changes according to reference position as shown below. If the CCRP is positioned outside of the effective display area, the bearing scale is indicated with the appropriate reduced detail. Radar antenna position is at center of display Conning position is at center of display ANT position CCRP position Range and bearing are measured and graphics are drawn according to reference position as in the table below. Markers, measurements and reference point Category Range and bearing measurement Item EBL VRM Cursor PI line Reference point CCRP Antenna position Range and bearing measured from CCRP Range and bearing measured from antenna position Drawn from CCRP Drawn from antenna position Range ring Drop mark Graphics Heading line Stern mark Beam line Own ship vector Own ship track 1-99 1. RADAR OPERATION Markers, measurements and reference point (con't) Category Item Reference point CCRP Antenna position Bearing cursor Drawn with CCRP at center Drawn with antenna position at center Course, speed Calculated with CCRP at center Calculated with antenna position at center CPA, TCPA Calculated with CCRP at center Calculated with antenna position at center BCR, BCT Calculated from bow position Own ship data Heading Speed Data from sensor, regardless of reference point selected Course over ground Speed over ground Own L/L Note: When the antenna is located some distance from the CCRP, the CCRP may be outside the bearing cursor in true motion or offcenter. Also, when the CCRP is set as reference point, some parts of the bearing cursor are not displayed. 1-100 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.51 Switching Hub HUB-100 (option) The HUB-100 provides switching for a card interface unit and multiple processor units (max. 7), using an Ethernet interface (100BASE-TX/10BASE-T). LEDs display link/activity, mode (full-duplex or half-duplex) and collision statuses. No operation is required of the user. Simply turn on the HUB-100’s AC power source to power it. LED display The LEDs on the top of the unit light, flash or go off according to equipment status. When the equipment is powered all LEDs light then go off. LEDs Switching Hub HUB-100 LED status and meaning LED Status Meaning Power Lit Off Equipment powered Equipment off Link/Act Lit Off Flashing Connection with terminal normal Connection with terminal disconnected Data TX or RX FDx/Col Lit Off Flashing Full-duplex Half-duplex Collision 100M Lit Off 100Mbps connection 10Mbps connection 1-101 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.52 Anchor Watch The anchor watch feature alerts you when your ship has traveled a distance greater than a threshold value, when it should be at rest. When the anchor watch is active, an orange dashed circle marks the anchor watch range. If your ship goes outside the circle, "ANCHOR WATCH" appears in the Alert Box. Alarm setting Your ship's position, where you start the anchor watch. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1-102 : Alarm triggered Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 2 [MARK]. Select 5 ANCHOR WATCH. Select ON. Roll the scrollwheel to set the alarm range, from 0-9.99 (nm). Push the right button to close the menu. 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.53 Drop Mark The operator inscribes a drop mark ( ) at a selected location to find the range and bearing from own ship to the mark. This can be useful for marking a point to avoid while navigating to a destination. 1.53.1 Activating the drop mark feature 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 2 [MARK]. [MARK] 1 BACK 2 OWN SHIP MARK OFF/MIN/SCALED 3 STERN MARK OFF/ON 4 [PI LINE] 5 ANCHOR WATCH OFF/ON 0.0NM 6 DROP MARK OFF/ON 7 [INS MARK] *1 8 EBL OFFSET BASE STAB GND/STAB HDG/ STAB NORTH 9 [EBL, VRM, CURSOR SET]*2 *1 [BARGE MARK] depending on installation preset. 0 RING *2 IMO and A types show OFF/ON 9 EBL CURSOR BEARING (REL/TRUE) 3. Select 6 DROP MARK. 4. Select ON. Two "DROP MARK" boxes appear at the bottom of the display. (See the figure on the next page.) 5. Push the right button several times to close the menu. 1-103 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.53.2 Inscribing a drop mark 1. Left-click one of the DROP MARK boxes at the bottom of the screen. 2. Put the cursor on the point you want to measure the range and bearing and push the left button. A drop mark is inscribed on the screen and range and bearing between own ship and the drop mark are shown below corresponding DROP MARK box. 340 350 000 010 020 330 030 320 040 310 050 060 300 070 290 280 080 270 090 260 100 250 110 240 120 Drop Mark 230 220 130 140 210 150 200 No. 1 DROP MARK box 190 180 170 160 DROP1 DROP2 229.8°T 4.532NM 90.38°T 2.873NM No. 2 DROP MARK box Range and bearing to drop mark 1.53.3 Erasing a drop mark Left-click the appropriate DROP MARK box until the drop mark and its data are erased. (The DROP MARK box remains on the screen until the drop mark feature is turned off from the menu.) 1-104 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.54 Sub Monitor (A, B, C and W types) The picture from a radar outside the LAN network can be shown on this radar (processor unit+display unit+control unit). 1. Put the cursor in the ANTENNA box at the upper left side of the screen. 2. Right-click to show the ANT SELECT menu. [ANT SELECT] ANT1: X-BAND 12 FORE ANT2: X-BAND 12 MAIN TOP ANT3: X-BAND 12 MAIN TOP ANT4: X-BAND 12 AFT OWN RADAR No.: 2 1 DISP1 ANT1 MASTER 2 DISP2 ANT2 MASTER 3 DISP3 ANT3 MASTER 4 DISP4 ANT4 MASTER 9 STORE INTER-SW NO/YES 0 SUB MONITOR* OFF/ON * Not available on IMO or A radar. 3. Spin the scrollwheel to select 0 SUB MONITOR then push the left button. 4. Spin the scrollwheel to select ON then push the left button. The antenna box shows "SUB" and the image from the sub monitor is shown on this radar 5. Push the right button to close the menu. Antenna-related functions of the sub monitor; for example, pulselength, cannot be controlled from this radar. 1-105 1. RADAR OPERATION 1.55 Net Cursor The net cursor is used to depict your fishing net on the radar display. It is especially useful for bottom trawlers for knowing where the net is located. Enter the dimensions of your net in the menu to show the net in scale on the display. EBL2 Net cursor 1.55.1 Activating the net cursor 1. Left-click the MENU box. 2. Select 2 [MARK] then push the left button. 3. Select 9 [EBL, VRM, CURSOR SET] then push the left button. [EBL, VRM, CURSOR SET] 1 BACK 2 EBL1 REL/TRUE 3 EBL2 REL/TRUE 4 VRM1 NM/SM/km/kyd 5 VRM2 NM/SM/km/kyd 6 CURSOR BEARING REL/TRUE 7 CURSOR RANGE NM/SM/km/kyd 8 [ CURSOR SHAPE] 9 CURSOR BRG SCALE 360°/32 POINTS 4. Select 8 [CURSOR SHAPE] then push the left button. 1-106 1. RADAR OPERATION [ CURSOR SHAPE] 1 BACK 2 CURSOR OFF/ON 3 FRONT HALF LENGTH 0.0m 4 REAR HALF LENGTH 0.0m 5 NET WIDTH 0.0m 6 ROTATE STEP 360°/32 POINTS WARP LENGTH 0.0m 5. Select 2 [CURSOR] then push the left button. 6. Select ON then push the left button to enable the net cursor. EBL2 is then automatically turned on. 7. Push the right button four times to close the menu. 1.55.2 Setting net cursor dimensions, adjusting net cursor orientation 1. Left-click the MENU box. 2. Select 2 [MARK] then push the left button. FRONT HALF 3. Select 9 [EBL, VRM, CURSOR LENGTH SET] then push the left button. 4. Select 8 [CURSOR SHAPE] then push the left button. NET WIDTH 5. Set net cursor dimensions as REAR HALF follows, referring to the illustration LENGTH at right. a) Select FRONT HALF LENGTH then push the left button. b) Spin the scrollwheel to set front half length (0-3000 m) then push the left button. c) Set REAR HALF LENGTH and NET WIDTH similarly. d) Warp length (a+b in the illustration at right) is indicated at the bottom of the menu. The net cursor is placed at the screen center, with its top and bottom points bisected by EBL2. To adjust the position of the net cursor, go to step 6. Otherwise, go to step 9. 6. Select 6 ROTATE STEP then push the left button. 7. Select 360° or 32 POINTS as appropriate then push the left button. These figures determine how finely to rotate the EBL2 when adjusting the orientation of the net cursor. Select 360° for fine rotation or 32 POINTS for coarse rotation. 8. Use the rotary encoder for the EBL to adjust the orientation of the net cursor. 1-107 1. RADAR OPERATION 9. Push the right button four times to close the menu. 10. Use the EBL offset feature to anchor the net cursor at net origin point. a) Push the EBL OFFSET key. b) Use the trackball to set net origin point. c) Push the EBL OFFSET key to anchor the net cursor. 11. Steer the vessel so your ship’s trail runs along the net cursor then throw the net. 1-108 2. RADAR OBSERVATION 2.1 General 2.1.1 Minimum and maximum ranges Minimum range The minimum range is defined by the shortest distance at which, using a scale of 1.5 or 0.75 nm, a target having an echoing area of 10 m2 is still shown separate from the point representing the antenna position. It is mainly dependent on the pulselength, antenna height, and signal processing such as main bang reduction and digital quantization. It is a good practice to use a shorter range scale as far as it gives favorable definition or clarity of picture. The IMO Resolution MSC.192(79) requires the minimum range to be less than 40 m, respectively. This series of radars satisfy this requirement. Maximum range The maximum detecting range of the radar, Rmax, varies considerably depending on several factors such as the height of the antenna above the waterline, the height of the target above the sea, the size, shape and material of the target, and the atmospheric conditions. Under normal atmospheric conditions, the maximum range is equal to the radar horizon or a little shorter. The radar horizon is longer than the optical one by about 6% because of the diffraction property of the radar signal. The Rmax is given in the following equation. R max = 2.2 x ( h1 + h2 ) where Rmax: radar horizon (nautical miles) h1: antenna height (m) h2 : target height (m) Radar horizon Optical horizon For example, if the height of the antenna above the waterline is 9 meters and the height of the target is 16 meters, the maximum radar range is; R max= 2.2 x ( 9 + 16 ) = 2.2 x (3 + 4) = 15.4 nm It should be noted that the detection range is reduced by precipitation (which absorbs the radar signal). 2-1 2. RADAR OBSERVATION X-band and S-band In fair weather, the equation on the previous page does not give a significant difference between X- and S-band radars. However, in heavy precipitation condition, an S-band radar would have better detection than an X-band radar. Radar resolution There are two important factors in radar resolution (discrimination): bearing resolution and range resolution. Bearing resolution Bearing resolution is the ability of the radar to display as separate pips the echoes received from two targets that are at the same range and close together. It is proportional to the antenna length and reciprocally proportional to the wavelength. The length of the antenna radiator should be selected for a bearing resolution better than 2.5° (IMO Resolution). This condition is normally satisfied with a radiator of 1.2 m (4 ft) or longer in the X-band. The S-band radar requires a radiator of about 12 feet (3.6 m) or longer. Range resolution Range resolution is the ability to display as separate pips the echoes received from two targets that are on the same bearing and close to each other. This is determined by pulselength only. Practically, a 0.08 microsecond pulse offers the discrimination better than 40 m as do so with all FURUNO radars. Test targets for determining the range and bearing resolution are radar reflectors having an echoing area of 10 m2. Bearing accuracy One of the most important features of the radar is how accurately the bearing of a target can be measured. The accuracy of bearing measurement basically depends on the narrowness of the radar beam. However, the bearing is usually taken relative to the ship’s heading, and thus, proper adjustment of the heading line at installation is an important factor in ensuring bearing accuracy. To minimize error when measuring the bearing of a target, put the target echo at the extreme position on the screen by selecting a suitable range. Range measurement Measurement of the range to a target is also a very important function of the radar. Generally, there are two means of measuring range: the fixed range rings and the variable range marker (VRM). The fixed range rings appear on the screen with a predetermined interval and provide a rough estimate of the range to a target. The variable range marker’s diameter is increased or decreased so that the marker touches the inner edge of the target, allowing the operator to obtain more accurate range measurements. 2-2 2. RADAR OBSERVATION 2.2 False Echoes Occasionally echo signals appear on the screen at positions where there is no target or disappear even if there are targets. They are, however, recognized if you understand the reason why they are displayed. Typical false echoes are shown below. Multiple echoes Multiple echoes occur when a transmitted pulse returns from a solid object like a large ship, bridge, or breakwater. A second, a third or more echoes may be observed on the display at double, triple or other multiples of the actual range of the target as shown below. Multiple reflection echoes can be reduced and often removed by decreasing the gain (sensitivity) or properly adjusting the A/C SEA control. True echo Target Own ship Multiple echo Multiple echoes Sidelobe echoes Every time the radar pulse is transmitted, some radiation escapes on each side of the beam, called "sidelobes." If a target exists where it can be detected by the side lobes as well as the main lobe, the side echoes may be represented on both sides of the true echo at the same range. Side lobes show usually only on short ranges and from strong targets. They can be reduced through careful reduction of the gain or proper adjustment of the A/C SEA control. Target A Target B (Spurious) Target B (True) Sidelobe echoes 2-3 2. RADAR OBSERVATION Virtual image A relatively large target close to your ship may be represented at two positions on the screen. One of them is the true echo directly reflected by the target and the other is a false echo which is caused by the mirror effect of a large object on or close to your ship as shown in the figure below. If your ship comes close to a large metal bridge, for example, such a false echo may temporarily be seen on the screen. Target ship Own ship True echo False echo Mirror image of target ship Virtual image Shadow sectors Funnels, stacks, masts, or derricks in the path of the antenna block the radar beam. If the angle subtended at the antenna is more than a few degrees, a non-detecting sector may be produced. Within this sector targets can not be detected. Radar antenna Radar mast Shadow sector Shadow sectors 2-4 2. RADAR OBSERVATION 2.3 SART (Search and Rescue Transponder) 2.3.1 SART description A Search and Rescue Transponder (SART) may be triggered by any X-Band (3 cm) radar within a range of approximately 8 nm. Each radar pulse received causes it to transmit a response which is swept repetitively across the complete radar frequency band. When interrogated, it first sweeps rapidly (0.4 µs) through the band before beginning a relatively slow sweep (7.5 µs) through the band back to the starting frequency. This process is repeated for a total of twelve complete cycles. At some point in each sweep, the SART frequency will match that of the interrogating radar and be within the pass band of the radar receiver. If the SART is within range, the frequency match during each of the 12 slow sweeps will produce a response on the radar display, thus a line of 12 dots equally spaced by about 0.64 nautical miles will be shown. When the radar to the SART is reduced to about 1 nm, the radar display my show also the 12 responses generated during the fast sweeps. These additional dot responses, which also are equally spaced by 0.64 nautical miles, will be interspersed with the original line of 12 dots. They will appear slightly weaker and smaller than the original dots. Screen B: When SART is close Screen A: When SART is distant Lines of 12 dots are displayed in concentric arcs. Echo from SART Radar antenna beamwidth 24 NM Echo from SART 1.5 NM Position of SART Own ship position 9500 MHz 9200 MHz Own ship position SART mark length 7.5 μs Sweep time Position of SART Radar receiver bandwidth 95 μs Low speed sweep signal Sweep start High speed sweep signal SART 2-5 2. RADAR OBSERVATION 2.3.2 Showing SART marks on the radar display This radar is equipped with a feature that optimally sets up the radar for SART detection. This feature automatically detunes the radar receiver out of its best tuning condition. This erases or weakens all normal radar echoes, but the SART marks are not erased because the SART response signal scans over all frequencies in the 9 GHz band. When the radar approaches the SART in operation, the SART marks will enlarge to large arcs, blurring a large part of the screen. To set up for SART detection do the following: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 1 [ECHO]. [ECHO] 1 BACK ND 2 2 ECHO REJ OFF/ON 3 TUNE INITIALIZE 4 PM OFF/ON 5 SART OFF/ON 6 WIPER OFF/1/2 7 ECHO AREA*1 CIRCLE/WIDE/ALL 8 [PICTURE SELECT] *1 Not available on IMO or A type 9 STC RANGE +00 ECHO menu 3. Select 5 SART. 4. Select ON. With SART turned on radar functions are set as follows: Range: 12 nm Pulselength: Long Echo Stretch: Off Noise Rejector: Off Echo Averaging: Off Interference Rejector: Off Performance Monitor: Off A/C RAIN: Off 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. "SART" appears at the bottom of the display when this feature is active. Be sure to turn off the SART feature when SART detection is no longer your objective. 2-6 2. RADAR OBSERVATION 2.3.3 General remarks on receiving SARTs SART range errors When responses from only the 12 low frequency sweeps are visible (when the SART is at a range greater than about 1 nm), the position at which the first dot is displayed may be as much as 0.64 nm beyond the true position of the SART. When the range closes so that the fast sweep responses are seen also, the first of these will be no more than 150 meters beyond the true position. Radar bandwidth This is normally matched to the radar pulselength and is usually switched with the range scale and the associated pulselength. Narrow bandwidths of 3-5 MHz are used with long pulses on long range scales and wide bandwidths of 10-25 MHz with short pulses on short ranges. A radar bandwidth of less than 5 MHz will attenuate the SART signal slightly, so it is preferable to use a medium bandwidth to ensure optimum detection of the SART. Radar side lobes As the SART is approached, side lobes from the radar antenna may show the SART responses as a series of arcs or concentric rings. These can be removed by the use of the anti-clutter sea control although it may be operationally useful to observe the side lobes as they may be easier to detect in clutter conditions and also they will confirm that the SART is near to own ship. Note: SART information excerpted from IMO SN/Circ 197 OPERATION OF MARINE RADAR FOR SART DETECTION. 2-7 2. RADAR OBSERVATION 2.4 RACON A RACON is a radar beacon that emits radar receivable signals in the radar frequency spectrum (X- or S-band). There are several signal formats; in general, the RACON signal appears on the radar screen as a rectangular echo originating at a point just beyond the position of the radar beacon. It has a Morse coded pattern. Note that the position on the radar display is not accurate. RACON RACON 2.5 Radar Target Enhancer (RTE) An RTE is a radar transponder is mounted on navigation buoys and masts of small crafts to significantly improve their detection by radar. Unlike a SART or RACON, which are passive, the RTE receives a radar signal, amplifies it and re-transmits it, with the intention of making the target's signal look larger on a radar display. The RTE is available in X-band and S-band types. 2-8 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.1 Usage Precautions WARNING No one navigational aid should be relied upon for the safety of vessel and crew. The navigator has the responsibility to check all aids available to confirm position. Electronic aids are not a substitute for basic navigational principles and common sense. • This TT automatically tracks automatically or manually acquired radar targets and calculates their courses and speeds, indicating them by vectors. Since the data generated by the auto plotter are based on what radar targets are selected, the radar must always be optimally tuned for use with the auto plotter, to ensure required targets will not be lost or unwanted targets such as sea returns and noise will not be acquired and tracked. • A target does not always mean a landmass, reef, ships or other surface vessels but can imply returns from sea surface and clutter. As the level of clutter changes with environment, the operator should properly adjust the A/C SEA, A/C RAIN and GAIN controls to be sure target echoes are not eliminated from the radar screen. CAUTION The plotting accuracy and response of this TT meets IMO standards. Tracking accuracy is affected by the following: • Tracking accuracy is affected by course change. One to two minutes is required to restore vectors to full accuracy after an abrupt course change. (The actual amount depends on gyrocompass specifications.) • The amount of tracking delay is inversely proportional to the relative speed of the target. Delay is on the order of 15—30 seconds for high relative speed; 30—60 seconds for low relative speed. • Display accuracy is affected by the following: - Echo intensity - Radar transmission pulsewidth - Radar bearing error - Gyrocompass error - Course change (own ship and target) The data generated by TT, AIS and video plotter are intended for reference only. Refer to official nautical charts for detailed and up-to-date information. 3-1 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.2 Controls for TT Keyboard The TT uses the keys shown below. BRILL OFF A/C RAIN A/C SEA GAIN ON EBL OFF ON HL OFF EBL OFFSET MODE F1 F2 OFF CENTER CU/TM RESET INDEX LINE F3 F4 VECTOR TIME VECTOR MODE TARGET LIST ALARM ACK STBY TX CANCEL TRAILS ENTER BRILL MARK VRM MENU ACQ TARGET DATA RANGE TARGET CANCEL ACQ: TARGET DATA: Manually acquires a target. Displays data on tracked target chosen with the trackball. TARGET CANCEL: Terminates tracking of tracked target chosen with the trackball. Control unit RCU-014 Trackball With the cursor inside the effective display area, you can access TT functions by rolling the scrollwheel or choosing appropriate TT function from the CURSOR menu. Roll the scrollwheel to show the following indications in the guidance box to access respective TT function: TT TARGET DATA & ACQ: TARGET CANCEL: 3-2 Manually acquires a target, or displays data of the cursor-selected tracked target. Cancels tracking on cursor-selected tracked target. 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.3 Activating, Deactivating TT To activate or deactivate the TT: Left-click the arrow in the TT ACQ MODE box at the right side of the display to show OFF, MAN, AUTO or AUTO MAN as appropriate TT AUTO MAN TT ACQ MODE box 3.4 Entering Own Ship's Speed The TT requires own ship's speed and heading data. The speed can be STW, SOG or echo-referenced speed (based on 3 max. stationary objects). Manual input is also possible. For automatic or manual input, see section 1.13. For echo-referenced speed input follow the procedure below. 3.4.1 Echo-referenced speed input The use of echo-referenced speed is recommended when: • The speed log is not operating properly or not connected to the radar. • The vessel has no device (doppler sonar, speed log, etc.) that can measure ship's bow-stern, port-starboard movement. If you select echo-referenced speed, the TT calculates own ship's speed relative to a fixed reference target. The number of targets may be R1, R2 or R3. When a plural of objects are selected, the mean value is used, for stabilization and speed. 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to display "REF MARK / EXIT" in the guidance box. 2. Select a small fixed island or any radar prominent point located at 0.2 to 24 nm from own ship. 3-3 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3. Push the left button to enter the reference mark. The reference target mark (see below) appears at the cursor position and the own ship position data label changes from "LOG," "NAV" or "MANUAL" to "REF." Note that it takes three minutes before a new speed is displayed. If tracking has failed for a reference target, the target is marked with a lost target mark (symbol formed with two triangles). changes to R1 in three minutes R1 Reference target 4. Repeat steps 2-3 to continue entering reference marks. Three may be entered. Notes on speed input by reference target • Reference targets are only used for the calculation of true speed. • Do not use reference target generated true speed to calculate relative speed. Relative speed data is not accurate because response to speed change is slow, hampering the TT's ability to accurately judge the possibility of collision. • Select a stationary target as a reference target to calculate own ship speed as ground tracking speed. Do not choose a moving target as a reference target. A moving target produces error in the vector for TT and AIS, which results in wrong collision avoidance information. Further, an unstable stationary target produces inaccurate speed data and the target itself may become lost. • When a reference target is lost or goes out of the acquisition range, that reference target mark blinks and the indication "REF TARGET LOST" appears in the alarm box. If all reference targets are lost, the speed indication reads "*.*" Select a different reference target if currently selected one is lost. • When all targets are deleted, the reference target mark is also deleted and the target-based speed becomes invalid. The speed is indicated as BTREF where BT means Bottom Track (speed over ground). • Reference targets may be marked with a vector. This can be done with 3 REF TARGET VECTOR on the TT TARGET menu. • Loss of reference target will affect the calculation of true speed and true course of targets. Further, own ship speed will be inaccurate. Canceling echo-referenced speed input Open the SPD menu, referring to section 1.13, and set 1 SHIP SPEED to LOG, NAV or MANUAL as appropriate. 3-4 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.5 Automatic Acquisition The FAR-2xx7 radars can acquire a maximum of 100 targets, the number of automatically and manually acquired targets determined by the TT TARGET menu setting. TT TARGET setting and target acquisition condition Menu Setting MANUAL100 AUTO25 AUTO50 AUTO75 AUTO100 Acquisition condition 100 targets manually 25 targets automatically, 75 targets manually 50 targets automatically, 50 targets manually 75 targets automatically, 25 targets manually 100 targets automatically A target just acquired automatically is marked with a broken square and a vector appears within one minute to indicate the target's motion trend. Within three minutes, the initial tracking stage is finished and the target becomes ready for stable tracking. At this point, the broken square mark changes to a solid circle. (Targets automatically acquired are distinguished from those acquired manually. The targets which are acquired manually are displayed with a thicker line.) 3.5.1 Enabling auto acquisition 1. Right-click the arrow in the TT ACQ MODE box to show the TT TARGET menu. [TT TARGET MENU] 1 TT SELECT MANUAL100/ AUTO 25/ AUTO 50/ AUTO 75/ AUTO 100 2 ALL CANCEL NO/YES 3 REF TARGET VECTOR OFF/ON TT TARGET menu 2. Select 1 TT SELECT. 3. Select automatic acquisition condition desired, referring to the table above for details. 4. Push the right button to close the menu. Note 1: The TT ACQ MODE box shows AUTO when the automatic acquisition condition is selected. Note 2: When the menu-set number of automatically acquired targets is reached, the message "TARGET-FULL (AUTO)" is displayed at the right-hand side of screen. 3-5 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.5.2 Terminating tracking of targets (including reference targets) When the TT has acquired the menu-set number of targets automatically, the message "TARGET-FULL(AUTO)(or MAN)" appears at the right side of the screen and no more auto acquisition occurs unless targets are lost. Should this happen, cancel tracking of less important targets or perform manual acquisition. Canceling individual targets By keyboard: 1. Use the trackball to put the cursor (+) on the tracked target, reference target or lost target you wish to cancel tracking. 2. Press the [TARGET CANCEL] key. By trackball: 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to show TARGET CANCEL / EXIT in the guidance box. 2. Put the cursor (+) on the tracked target, reference target or lost target you wish to cancel tracking. 3. Push the left button to cancel tracking on the target selected. 4. To finish, push the right button. Canceling tracking on all targets 1. Right-click the TT ACQ MODE box at the right side of the screen to show the TT TARGET menu. [TT TARGET MENU] 1 TT SELECT MANUAL100/ AUTO 25/ AUTO 50/ AUTO 75/ AUTO 100 3 ALL CANCEL NO/YES 3 REF TARGET VECTOR OFF/ON TT TARGET menu 2. Select 2 ALL CANCEL and YES. 3. Push the left button to cancel tracking on all tracked targets. 3-6 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.6 Manual Acquisition Maximum 100 targets may be acquired manually depending on the acquisition condition set on the TT TGT menu. 3.6.1 Setting manual acquisition conditions 1. Right-click the arrow in the TT ACQ MODE box at the right side to show the TT TARGET menu. [TT TARGET MENU] 1 TT SELECT MANUAL100/ AUTO 25/ AUTO 50/ AUTO 75/ AUTO 100 4 ALL CANCEL NO/YES 3 REF TARGET VECTOR OFF/ON TT TARGET menu 2. Select 1 TT SELECT. 3. Select MANUAL 100, AUTO 25, AUTO 50 or AUTO 75 as appropriate. For details see the table on page 3-5. 4. Push the right button to close the menu. 3.6.2 Manually acquiring targets By keyboard 1. Put the cursor on the target you want to acquire. 2. Press the [ACQ] key. By trackball 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to show "TT TARGET DATA & ACQ" in the guidance box. 2. Put the cursor on the target you want to acquire. 3. Push the left button to acquire the target. 3-7 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) The plotting symbol is drawn by broken lines during the initial acquisition stage. A vector appears in about one minute after acquisition indicating the target's motion trend. If the target is consistently detected for three minutes, the plotting symbol changes to a solid circle. If acquisition fails, the target plotting symbol blinks and disappears shortly. TT Symbol Meaning Immediately after acquisition, this plotting symbol is shown in broken lines. Within one minute after acquisition, a vector appears to show a trend of movement. Within three minutes after acquisition, the plotting symbol changes to a small circle, indicating steady-state tracking condition. Note 1: For successful acquisition, the target to be acquired should be within 0.1 to 24 nm (or 32 nm, depending on initial setting) from own ship and not obscured by sea or rain clutter. Note 2: When the capacity for manual acquisition is reached, the message "TARGET FULL(MAN)" is displayed at the screen bottom. Cancel tracking of non-threatening targets if you wish to acquire additional targets manually. Note 3: Target number is normally not shown. On the A, B, C and W type radars it appears when the cursor is placed on a TT symbol. CAUTION Target Swap When a target being tracked nears another target being tracked, the targets may be "swapped". When two targets acquired either automatically or manually come close to each other, one of the two may become a Lost Target. Should this happen, manual re-acquisition of the Lost Target may be required after the two have separated. 3-8 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.7 Lost Target Targets not detected in five consecutive scans become "lost targets." A lost target is shown in the display with flashing red "X". Flashing stops after lost target alarm is acknowledged. If you are in an area where tracked targets are lost frequently you may want to disable the lost target alarm against tracked targets by maximum range or minimum speed. 3.7.1 Setting the lost target filter You can set the lost target alarm to sound against lost TTs that are within a specific range or ship speed. Set the criteria as below. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 4 [TT AIS] to open the TT AIS menu. 3. Select 9 [TT LOST FILTER]. [TT LOST ALM FILTER] 1 BACK 2 MAX RANGE OFF/ON 0NM 3 MIN SHIP SPEED OFF/ON 0.0kn 4. Set items 2 and 3 as appropriate, referring to the description below. MAX RANGE: Any TT lost targets beyond this range will not trigger the lost target alarm. MIN SHIP SPEED: Any TT lost targets slower than this setting will not trigger the lost target alarm. 5. Push the right button several times to close the menu. Note: Reference targets are not affected by this filter. 3.7.2 Enabling, disabling the lost target alarm The LOST TARGET ALARM box at the bottom right corner enables and disables the lost target alarm. Select OFF, ALL or FILT as appropriate. OFF: Disable the alarm ALL: Get the alarm against all lost targets. LOST TARGET ALAEM OFF FILT: Get the alarm against the targets whose criteria meet the settings on the TT LOST LOST TARGET box ALM FILTER menu. 3-9 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.8 TT Symbols and Attributes 3.8.1 TT symbols The symbols used in this equipment comply with IEC 62288. Item Symbol Status Remarks Automatically Initial stage Broken circle around an echo to indicate the target under acquisition and initial acquired targets stage of tracking, before steady-state tracking. Within one minute after acquisition (vector still unreliable). Steady tracking Solid circle with vector indicating steady state tracking (within three minutes after acquisition). CPA alarm Plotting symbol (red) flashes to indicate the target is predicted to come into CPA or (flashing) TCPA. CPA alarm Shown in red, and flashing stops after acknowledge CPA/TCPA alarm is acknowledged. Lost target A red X is crossed through the TT symbol to indicate that it is a lost target. Flashing (flashing) stops after lost target alarm is acknowledged. Manually Initial stage Plotting symbol selected for a target acquired manually is shown in bold broken acquired targets lines. (the width of the line for "steady Within one minute after acquisition. tracking" TT is thicker than that Steady tracking Manual plotting symbol in a bold solid of the autocircle (within three minutes after matically acquisition). acquired target) CPA alarm Plotting symbol (red) flashes to indicate the target is predicted to come into CPA or (collision course) (flashing) TCPA. Flashing stops after CPA/TCPA alarm is acknowledged. Lost target A red X is superimposed on the TT symbol to indicate a lost target. Flashing stops (flashing) after lost target alarm is acknowledged. On target passing Symbol is red and flashing. Acquisition zone through operator-set acquisition zone (flashing) Target selected On selected target Target data (range, bearing, course, speed, CPA, TCPA, BCR, BCT, etc.). for data readout Reference target After three minutes, changes to ○R 3-10 On reference target Used to calculate own ship’s over-the-ground speed (echo-referenced speed) for ground stabilization. 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) Other TT symbols Item Symbol Trial maneuver Status Bottom center Appears during execution of a trial maneuver. Bottom center Appears during performance test. (flashing) Performance test 3.8.2 Remarks (flashing) Choosing TT symbol (B, C and W types) In addition to the "standard" circle TT symbol, you may select from the symbols shown below, using the full keyboard. This cannot be done with trackball-type control unit (RCU-015, RCU-016). However, you can program a function key to do so, with the combination of the "STD KEY" category and the option "TARGET DATA." 1. Put the cursor on the TT symbol you want to change. 2. Press the [TARGET DATA] key. 3. Press the [TARGET DATA] key until desired symbol is displayed. 3.8.3 TT symbol brilliance 1. Right-click the BRILL box at the left side of the screen. 2. Select 0 NEXT. [BRILL1 MENU (2/2)] BACK BRG CURSOR EBL VRM PI LINE TT SYMBOL AIS SYMBOL L/L GRID MARK CHART BRILL menu, page 2 3. Select 6 TT SYMBOL. 4. Roll the scrollwheel to adjust brilliance. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 3-11 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.8.4 TT symbol color You may select the color for the TT symbol as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 4 [TT•AIS] to open the TT AIS menu. [TT•AIS] 1 BACK 2 AZ STAB STAB HDG/STAB NORTH 3 AZ POLYGON OFF/STAB GND/ STAB HDG/STAB NORTH 4 [TRIAL MANEUVER] 5 [TT•AIS SYMBOL] 6 [CPA AUTO ACTIVATE] 7 [AIS DISP FILTER] 8 [AIS LOST FILTER] 9 [TT LOST FILTER] 0 [ASSOCIATION] TT•AIS menu 3. Select 5 [TT•AIS SYMBOL]. [TT•AIS SYMBOL] 1 BACK 2 TT•AIS SYMBOL COLOR RED*/GRN/BLU/YEL*/ CYA/MAG/WHT 3 AIS ROT TAG LIMIT 0.000°/MIN 4 TT PAST POSN POINTS 5/10 5 AIS PAST POSN POINTS 5/10 6 AIS SCALED SYMBOL OFF/ON 3-12 * Not available on IMO type 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.9 Displaying Target Data The TT mode provides the full functionality of TT as required by the IMO Resolution A.823(19) and IEC 62288, including display of range, bearing, course, speed, CPA and TCPA of all tracked targets. The target bearing is show in relative bearing in the head-up mode and true bearing in the course-up, north-up and true motion modes, with the suffix "R" (Relative) or "T" (True). The target speed and course are shown as speed over the ground or speed through the water depending on speed source. 3.9.1 Displaying target data By keyboard Use the trackball to put the cursor on a desired tracked target and press the [TARGET DATA] key. The target’s shape changes to a square. To erase a target’s data from the data box, press the key again. By trackball 1. With cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to show "TARGET DATA & ACQ / CURSOR MENU" in the guidance box. 2. Use the trackball to put the cursor on a desired tracked target then push the left button. 3. To erase a target’s data from the data box, select the target on the radar display then push the left button. Target data display is as below. RNG/BRG: Range and bearing from own ship to the selected target with suffix "T" (True) or "R" (Relative). COG/SOG (in case of GPS): Course and speed are displayed for the selected target with suffix "T" (True) or "R" (relative). CSE/STW are shown for manual speed and speed through the water. CPA/TCPA: CPA (Closest Point of Approach) is the closest range a target will approach to own ship. TCPA is the time to CPA. Both CPA and TCPA are automatically calculated. When the CPA has passed clear of own ship, it is indicated by a TCPA with a negative (-) sign. TCPA is counted to 99.9 min and beyond this, it is indicate as TCPA> -99.9MIN. BCR/BCT: BCR is the closest range at which the selected target is predicted to cross your ship’s bow. BCT is the time at which the selected target is predicted to cross your ship’s bow. 3-13 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) Target selected for data readout 340 350 000 010 020 330 030 320 040 310 050 300 060 01 070 290 280 080 270 090 260 100 250 110 240 120 230 TT TARGET No. 01 BRG 25.5°T RNG 3.4NM T COG 205.1°T* T SOG 12.3KN* CPA 2.9NM TCPA 12.2MIN BCR 1.7NM BCT 20MIN 130 140 220 210 150 200 190 180 170 * CSE and STW are shown in case of manual speed, speed through the water. 160 BRG: Bearing from own ship to target in R (Relative) or T (True) RNG: Range from own ship to target COG: Course of target over ground, True or Relative* SOG: Speed of target over ground* CPA: Closest Point of Approach of target to own ship TCPA: Time to CPA BCR: Bow crossing range of target BCT: Bow crossing time of target Tracked target display You may display the target data for two targets in one data box and the data for as many as six targets can be displayed. For further details, see section 1.42. Removing a target data display Full keyboard: Put the cursor on the data you want to remove then hit the [TARGET DATA] key. Cursor menu: TARGET DATA & ACQ Canceling tracking on a target from target data display Full keyboard: Put the cursor on the data you want to remove then hit the [TARGET CANCEL] key. Cursor menu: TARGET CANCEL 3-14 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.9.2 Target list The target list provides a comprehensive data display of all TT (and AIS) targets being tracked. Displaying the target list To display the target list, do the following: 1. Select the TARGET LIST box at the right side of the screen. TARGET LIST TARGET LIST box 2. Push the left button to display the TARGET LIST. ">" in the TCPA means that the time is greater than 99:59. [TARGET LIST (1/1)] SORT BY CPA 1 BACK 2 TT TARGET No: 01 BRG 16.5°T RNG 2.05 NM CPA 0.17NM TCPA>99.59M 3 TT TARGET No: 02 BRG 19.0°T RNG 2.49 NM CPA 0.29NM TCPA>99.59M 9 REFRESH DATA Target list 3. To scroll the list when there are more than three targets, select 0 NEXT. Note: To refresh data, select 9 REFRESH DATA then push the scrollwheel. This is not necessary when the sorting method is changed (see next page); data is automatically updated whenever the sorting method is changed. 4. Push the right button to close the list. 3-15 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) Sorting the target list You may sort the target list by CPA, TCPA, BCR, BCT, RANGE or SPEED as follows: 72 nm or 96 nm range scale 1. Right-click the TARGET LIST box. [TARGET LIST MENU] 1 SORT BY CPA/TCPA/BCR/BCT/ RANGE/SPEED TARGET LIST menu 2. Select 1 SORT BY. 3. Select sorting method desired. 4. Push the right button to close the menu. 3.10 Vector Modes Target vectors can be displayed relative to own ship's heading (Relative) or north (True). 3.10.1 Description of vectors Ground stabilization and sea stabilization Target vectors can be ground stabilized or sea stabilized. You can select ground or sea stabilization from the SPEED menu. Select BT(Bottom Tracking) for ground stabilization or WT(Water Tracking) for sea stabilization. The TT VECTOR box shows the stabilization mode as TRUE-G or TRUE-S. Sea stabilization is a mode where own ship and all targets are referenced to the sea using a compass heading and single-axis log water speed inputs. Ground stabilization is a mode where own ship and all targets are referenced to the ground using the ground track or set and drift inputs. If the accuracy seems unsatisfactory, enter set and drift corrections. Note that set and drift cannot be used on the IMO radar when the radar is displaying AIS targets. 3-16 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) True vector Own ship and other ship's move on the display at their true speeds and courses. This mode is useful for distinguishing moving targets from stationary ones. Buoy Buoy Target on collision course Own ship Own ship True vectors in head-up mode Relative vectors in head-up mode True and relative vectors Relative vector Other ships move relative to your ship. This mode is useful for finding ships on a collision course with your ship. A ship whose vector passes through your ship's position is on a collision course. 3.10.2 Vector mode and length Vectors may be displayed in true or relative mode. Vector time (or the length of vectors) can be set between 1 and 60 minutes. By keyboard 1. Press the [VECTOR MODE] key consecutively to select relative or true vector mode. Your selection is shown on the vector motion box. (Note that this also selects the vector mode for the past position display.) 2. Press the [VECTOR TIME] key consecutively to select vector time. Your selection appears in the vector time box (see illustration below). By trackball 1. Use the trackball to select VECTOR TRUE-S(or -G) or VECTOR REL (whichever is displayed) at the right side of the screen. Vector mode VECTOR TRUE-S* * TRUE or REL S: Sea stablized G: Ground stabilized (No stabilization indication in relative.) 15MIN Vector time TT VECTOR boxes 3-17 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 2. Push the left button to display VECTOR TRUE-S(or -G) or VECTOR REL as appropriate. (Note that this also selects the vector mode for the past position display.) 3. Do one of the following to select a vector time. Control Left button Available setting 30 sec, 1-15 min (1 min interval), 20 min, 30 min, 40 min, 50 min, 60 min Scrollwheel 30 sec, 1-60 min (1 min interval) The vector tip shows an estimated position of the target after the selected vector time elapses. It can be valuable to extend the vector length to evaluate the risk of collision with any target. 3.11 Past Position Display The past position display shows equally time-spaced dots marking the past positions of any targets being tracked. A new dot is added every minute (or at other preset time intervals) until the preset number is reached. If a target changes its speed, the spacing will be uneven. If it changes the course, its plotted course will not be a straight line. Past position orientation, true or relative, is controlled with TRAIL MODE on the TRAIL menu. See section 1.30.1 for the procedure. (a) Ship turning (b) Ship running straight (c) Ship reduced speed (d) Ship increased speed Past position display 3.11.1 Displaying and erasing past position points, choosing past position plot interval 1. Use the trackball to select the PAST POSN box. PAST POSN REL 2MIN PAST POSN box 2. Push the left button or scrollwheel to select plot interval desired: OFF, 30 seconds, 1, 2, 3 or 6 minutes. Select OFF to erase all past position points and deactivate the past position display. 3-18 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.11.2 Past position display attributes You may select the number of past points to display per plotting interval as follows. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 4 [TT•AIS]. [TT•AIS] 1 BACK 2 AZ ZONE STAB STAB HDG/STAB NORTH 3 AZ POLYGON OFF/STAB GND/ STAB HDG/STAB NORTH 4 [TRIAL MANEUVER] 5 [TT•AIS SYMBOL] 6 [CPA AUTO ACTIVATE] 7 [AIS DISP FILTER] 8 [AIS LOST FILTER 9 [TT LOST FILTER] 0 [ASSOCIATION] 3. Select 5 [TT•AIS SYMBOL]. [TT•AIS SYMBOL] 1 BACK 2 TT•AIS SYMBOL COLOR RED*/GRN/BLU/YEL*/ CYA/MAG/WHT 3 AIS ROT TAG LIMIT 0.000°/MIN 4 TT PAST POSN POINTS 5/10 5 AIS PAST POSN POINTS 5/10 6 AIS SCALED SYMBOL OFF/ON * Not available on IMO radar TT•AIS SYMBOL menu 4. Select 4 TT PAST POSN POINTS. 5. Select 5 or 10 as appropriate. 6. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 3.11.3 Past position display mode The display mode for the past position display is the same as that set for the TT vector. In the true motion mode, the true vector is displayed. 3-19 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.11.4 Stabilization in true mode The true mode past position display may be ground stabilized or sea stabilized. The PAST POSN box shows current stabilization as TRUE-G or TRUE-S. To change stabilization mode, open the SPEED menu and set SHIP SPEED to BT (ground stabilization) or WT (sea stabilization). 3.12 Set and Drift Set, the direction in which a water current flows, can be manually entered in 0.1-degree steps. Drift, in another word Rate, the speed of tide, can also be entered manually in 0.1 knot steps. When course through water and speed through water are available, activate set and drift to get course over ground and speed over ground. Set and drift corrections are beneficial for increasing the accuracy of vectors and target data. Refer to the tide table on board the ship for setting information. These values are applied to all targets. If stationary targets have vectors, set and drift values should be adjusted until they lose vectors. To enter set and drift do the following: [SPEED MENU] 1 SHIP SPEED 1. Right-click the SPD box to show the SPEED LOG(BT)/LOG(WT)/ menu. GPS/MANUAL/REF 2. Select 3 SET DRIFT. 2 MANUAL SPEED 3. Select ON. 0.0kn 3 SET DRIFT 4. Push the right button to close the menu. Then, OFF/ON the SET and DRIFT boxes appear at the top of the display. 5. Select the SET box. SET 66.8°T 6. Use the scrollwheel to set value, rolling it to select numeral and pushing it to set. (Setting range: 000.0 – SET box 359.9 (°T)) DRIFT 7.2kn 7. Select the DRIFT box. 8. Use the scrollwheel to set value, rolling it to select DRIFT box numeral and pushing it to set. (Setting range: 00.0 – 19.9(kn)) Note 1: Set and drift are available when using manually input speed, speed through the water. The speed source is shown as "WTC" (Water Tracking Count). Note 2: Set and drift should be checked periodically for correctness. Note 3: Set and drift can also be adjusted with the EBL and VRM. Put the cursor in either the SET or DRIFT box and operate the EBL for set and VRM for drift. 3-20 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.13 TT Collision Alarm (CPA, TCPA) The TT continuously monitors the predicted CAUTION range at the Closest Point of Approach (CPA) and predicted time to CPA (TCPA) of CPA/TCPA Alarm each TT. When the predicted CPA of any The CPA and TCPA alarm feature should never be relied upon as the sole means for TT becomes smaller than a preset CPA detecting the risk of collision.The navigator range and its predicted TCPA less than a is not relieved of the responsibility to keep visual lookout for avoiding collisions, preset TCPA limit, the audio alarm sounds whether or not the radar or other plotting and TT COLLISION appears (in red) in the aid is in use. Alert Box. In addition, the symbol of the offending TT is red and flashes together with its vector. This feature, when used correctly, helps prevent the risk of collision by alerting you to threatening targets. It is important that GAIN, A/C SEA, A/C RAIN and other radar controls are properly adjusted. CPA and TCPA ranges must be set up properly taking into consideration the size, tonnage, speed, turning performance and other characteristics of own ship. The reference point for CPA and TCPA calculation may be selected from antenna position or conning position. For further details, see section 1.50. 3.13.1 Setting the CPA and TCPA ranges To set the CPA and TCPA ranges, do the following: 1. Left-click CPA LIMIT box to show the CPA and TCPA boxes. CPA LIMIT Box CPA Box CPA LIMIT 0.5NM 10MIN TCPA Box CPA LIMIT, CPA and TCPA boxes 2. Select the CPA Box. 3. Push the left button or scrollwheel to select CPA value. Left button Scrollwheel 0.5, 1, 1.5, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6(nm) 0.1-20(nm), 0-10 nm in 0.1 nm increments, 10 nm increments thereafter 4. Select the TCPA box. 5. Push the left button or scrollwheel to select TCPA value. Left button Scrollwheel 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 12, 15(minutes) 1-60 minutes, 1-minute increment 3-21 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.13.2 Acknowledging the TT collision alarm Press the [ALARM ACK] key on the keyboard, or select the ALARM ACK box with the trackball then push the left button to acknowledge the alarm and silence the buzzer. The warning label TT COLLISION and the flashing of the triangle plotting symbol and vector remain in the Alert Box until the dangerous situation is gone or you intentionally terminate tracking of the target. Note that when the TT COLLISION alarm is generated the AIS display is automatically turned on. 3.14 Acquisition Zone The acquisition zone functions both to alert you targets in a specific area and acts as an automatic acquisition area when automatic target acquisition is active. Any targets entering the zone will be automatically acquired. When a target enters an acquisition zone, the buzzer sounds and the indication TT NEW TARGET (or AIS NEW TARGET) appears (in red) in the Alert Box. The symbol of the offending target is red and flashing. Further, the AIS display is automatically turned on if it is off. 3.14.1 Activating an acquisition zone One or two acquisition zones may be activated. The No. 1 acquisition zone is available between 3 and 6 nm and the No. 2 acquisition zone can be set anywhere when the No. 1 zone is already in use. The TT/AIS acquisition zone’s lines are white and dashed so as to distinguish them from the radar target alarm. The procedure below shows how to set an acquisition zone, using the example at the bottom of the page. 1. Use the trackball to select one of the AZ (Acquisition Zone) boxes at the right side of the screen. AZ 1 AZ 2 Acquisition zone status Blank: Cancel acquisition zone SET: Set acquisition zone WORK: Activate acquisition zone SLEEP: Sleep acquisition zone AZ boxes 2. Push the left button. The AZ box now reads "AZx SET." 3. Put the cursor on point A then push the left button. 4. Put the cursor on point B then push the left button. The AZ box now reads "AZx WORK." 3-22 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 0.5-1 nm Target in acquision zone is red and flashing. If you are setting a polygon acquisition zone with AZ2, set at least three points. Push the right button to finish. Note that the status indication should be WORK or SLEEP to set AZ2. When a TT or AIS target enters the zone, the indication TT NEW TARGET or AIS NEW TARGET appears (in red) in the Alert Box and the offending target flashes. For the AIS, all sleeping targets are changed to activated targets. Note 1: If you wish to create an acquisition zone having a 360-degree coverage around own ship, set point B in almost the same direction (approx. ±3°) as point A then push the left button. Note 2: If the range scale is changed to less than half of the acquisition zone, "Azx (x=1 or 2) OUT" is shown in light-blue in the AZ box.If the left button is pushed in this state, the acquisition zone goes into "sleep" state and the guidance box reads "AZ WORK L = DELETE." Note 3: The default acquisition zone is fan shaped. It may also be a polygon having 3-10 points. For details, see section 3.14.5. Note 4: If both acquisition zones are displayed, maximum of four polygon points are shown. Note 5: TT and AIS are automatically set to TT=AUTO and AIS=DISP, respectively, when an AZ is activated in the following conditions: TT: TT=OFF or TT=MANUAL 100 AIS: AIS FUNC=OFF or AIS DISP=OFF 3.14.2 Sleeping, deactivating an acquisition zone 1. Select the appropriate AZ box. 2. Sleep or deactivate the alarm zone as appropriate: Sleep alarm zone: Push the left button to remove the acquisition zone from the screen. The indication in the AZ box changes from "AZx WORK" to "AZx SLEEP." To reactivate and display the acquisition zone, repeat this procedure to display "AZx WORK." Deactivate alarm zone: Push and hold down the left button until the AZ box goes blank. 3.14.3 Acknowledging the alarm Press the [ALARM ACK] key, or select the ALARM ACK box then push the left button to acknowledge the alarm and silence the buzzer. 3-23 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.14.4 Acquisition zone reference The acquisition zone may be referenced to heading or North as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 4 [TT•AIS] to open the TT•AIS menu. [TT•AIS] 1 BACK 2 AZ STAB STAB HDG/STAB NORTH 3 AZ POLYGON OFF/STAB GND/ STAB HDG/STAB NORTH 4 [TRIAL MANEUVER] 5 [TT•AIS SYMBOL] 6 [CPA AUTO ACTIVATE] 7 [AIS DISP FILTER] 8 [AIS LOST FILTER OFF/ON 9 [TT LOST FILTER] 0 [ASSOCIATION] TT•AIS menu 3. Select 2 AZ STAB. 4. Select STAB HDG or STAB NORTH as appropriate. STAB HDG: Acquisition zone keeps position relation with your ship. STAB NORTH: Acquisition zone is fixed to North. 5. Push the right button twice to close menu. 3.14.5 Acquisition zone shape and stabilization The shape of the No. 2 acquisition zone may be a sector or a polygon having up to 10 points. (The shape of the No.1 acquisition zone is always a sector.) 1. 2. 3. 4. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 4 [TT AIS] to open the TT AIS menu. Select 3 AZ POLYGON. Select OFF, STAB GND, STAB HDG or STAB NORTH as appropriate. OFF: Acquisition zone is a sector; number of points is limited to four. Stabilized against land. STAB GND: Polygon having 3-10 points. Stabilized against ground. STAB HDG: Polygon having 3-10 points. Stabilized against heading. STAB NORTH: Polygon having 3-10 points. Stabilized against North. 5. Push the right button twice to close menu. 3-24 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.15 TT System Messages There are seven main situations that cause the TT to trigger audio and visual alarms: • • • • • • • Reference target alarm Collision alarm Acquisition zone alarm Lost target alarm Target full alarm for manual acquisition Target full alarm for automatic acquisition System failure To acknowledge the audio alarm, press the [ALARM ACK] key, or select the ALARM ACK box then push the left button. TT system messages Message REF TARGET LOST TT COLLISION Meaning When the system detects a loss of a reference target, the target symbol turns red and flashes. At the same time, an audio alarm is produced for one second. The reference target mark disappears from the screen after the reference target alarm is acknowledged. A tracked target is on collision course. TT NEW TARGET Tracked target has entered an acquisition zone. The tracked target's symbol is red and flashing. TT LOST When the system detects a loss of a tracked target, the lost tracked target symbol appears in red and flashes. At the same time, an audio alarm is produced for one second. The lost target mark disappears from the screen after the lost target alarm is acknowledged. Appears when capacity for automatically(manually) tracked targets is 95% full. Appears when capacity for automatically(manually) acquired targets is full. When the TT malfunctions because of hardware error, the screen shows this indication. TT TARGET 95% (AUTO) or (MAN) TT TARGET FULL (AUTO) or (MAN) TT SYSTEM ERROR Action Press the [ALARM ACK] key or click the ALARM ACK box to acknowledge. Take evasive action or terminate tracking of TT. Press the [ALARM ACK] key or click the ALARM ACK box to acknowledge. Press the [ALARM ACK] key or click the ALARM ACK box to acknowledge. Press the [ALARM ACK] key or click the ALARM ACK box to acknowledge. Reset power to restore normal operation. 3-25 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.16 Trial Maneuver The trial maneuver feature simulates the effect on all tracked targets against own ship's maneuver. Enter your expected course, speed and time-to-maneuver to find the relationship between your ship and other ships against your planned maneuver. Further, set CPA and TCPA values to find possible collision situations. Enter various courses and speeds until a dangerous situation is resolved. The trial manuever feature proceeds without interrupting the updating of target information. For more accurate results, use relative motion and sea stabilization (ground tracking) and be sure that own ship's characteristics such as acceleration and turning performance have been properly set in the initial settings during the installation. Take into consideration own ship's maneuvering characteristics such as rudder delay, turning delay and acceleration delay. This is particularly important on large vessels. 3.16.1 Types of trial maneuvers There are two types of trial maneuvers: static and dynamic. Dynamic trial maneuver A dynamic trial maneuver displays predicted positions of the tracked targets and own ship. You enter own ship's intended speed and course with a certain "delay time." Assuming that all tracked targets maintain their present speeds and courses, the targets' and own ship's future movements are simulated in one-second increments indicating their predicted positions in 30-second intervals as illustrated below. Delay time = 2 m 30 s. Present own ship position The delay time represents the time lag from the present time to the time when own ship will actually start to change her speed and/or course. How much the delay is set the situation starts immediately and is updated every 0.5 seconds. In the example shown below, own ship will advance straight ahead (even after a maneuver) for a delay time of 2:30 then alters speed and course until operator-specified intended speed and course are achieved (position OS5 in this example). OS6 and OS7 show changes in course and speed and OS8 show that the ship has completed course and speed adjustments. 3-26 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) Static trial maneuver The static trial maneuver shows the relationship between your ship and tracked targets at the completetion of the trial maneuver. Enter expected course and speed and delay time until start of a maneuver and the expected position of your ship and tracked targets at the end of the trial maneuver are shown on the display. By shortening and extending the trial time you can find the safe time to make a maneuver. Thus, the static trial maneuver will be convenient when you wish to know the maneuver result immediately. Position of target B at end of trial maneuver Course and speed changes completed; position where course and speed are changed Position of target A at end of trial maneuver Delay time Current position of your ship 3.16.2 Performing a trial maneuver To perform a trial maneuver, do the following: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 4 [TT•AIS] to open the TT•AIS menu. [TT•AIS] 1 BACK 2 AZ STAB STAB HDG/STAB NORTH 4 AZ POLYGON OFF/STAB GND/ STAB HDG/STAB NORTH 4 [TRIAL MANEUVER] 5 [TT•AIS SYMBOL] 6 [CPA AUTO ACTIVATE] 7 [AIS DISP FILTER] 8 [AIS LOST FILTER OFF/ON 9 [TT LOST FILTER] 0 [ASSOCIATION] TT•AIS menu 3-27 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3. Select 4 [TRIAL MANEUVER]. [TRIAL MANEUVER] 1 BACK 2 TRIAL OFF/STATIC/DYNAMIC 3 TRIAL SPEED RATE 0kn 0.00kn/s 0kn 0.00kn/s 4 TRIAL TURN RATE 0kn 0.0°/s 0kn 0.0°/s TRIAL MANEUVER menu 4. Select 2 TRIAL. 5. Select STATIC or DYNAMIC as appropriate. The TRAIL box appears at the upper right corner. TRIAL OFF 6. Select 3 TRIAL SPEED RATE. Set trial speed rate with the scrollwheel, in the upper box. 7. Select 4 TRIAL TURN RATE. Set trial turn rate with the scrollwheel, in the upper box. Note: Two sets of trial speed and trial turn rate combinations are provided. Enter the data by sets as shown in the figure below. This is done to provide accurate trial maneuver results for various ship’s speed. 3 TRIAL SPEED RATE 0kt 0.00kn/s 0kt 0.00kn/s 4 TRIAL TURN RATE Set 1 0kt 0.0°/s Set 2 0kt 0.0°/s Set 1 Set 2 Set speed and turn rate to zero (0) to simulate course and speed changes not affected by ship’s inertia. 8. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 9. Use the trackball to select the TRIAL box and push the left button. Then, the TRIAL box reads TRIAL SET and boxes appear above the TRIAL box as below. TRIAL SET 00:00 DELAY 00:30 86.8°T 06.5kn Trial time Delay time for trial maneuver Course for trial maneuver Speed for trial maneuver Boxes for setting trial maneuver parameters 10. Use the scrollwheel to set delay time at DELAY. This is the time after which own ship takes a new situation, not the time the simulation begins. Change the delay time according to own ship loading condition, etc. Use the scrollwheel to set the delay time. 11. Select the course setting box. Use the scrollwheel to set the course 3-28 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 12. Select the speed setting box. Use the scrollwheel to set the speed. Note: Course and speed may also be set with the EBL and VRM, respectively. Put the cursor in any one of the four trial maneuver related boxes and operate applicable control. 13. Select TRIAL SET. Push the left button or the scrollwheel. The TRIAL box shows "TRAIL 00:00" (00:00 is trial maneuver time). The time indication depends on trial mode: Dynamic mode: The position of your ship and tracked targets is updated and displayed every 30 seconds. Static mode: The position of your ship and tracked targets when set course and speed are reached are displayed. The progress time until the position is reached is indicated on the display. The trial time can be changed from the Trial Time box. Put the cursor in the Trial Time box and roll the scrollwheel. The position of targets at the end of selected time is shown. Increase or decrease the time to get a safe manuever. When the cursor is removed from the box the original positions of your ship and tracked targets are restored. If a manuever is unsafe, change speed, course and delay until it is safe. The trial maneuver takes place with the letter "T" displayed at the bottom of the screen. The time appears at the top right side of the display. If any tracked target is predicted to be on a collision course with own ship (that is, the target ship comes within preset CPA/TCPA limits), the target plotting symbol is red. If this happens, change own ship's trial speed, course or delay time to obtain a safe maneuver. 3.16.3 Terminating a trial maneuver A trial maneuver is automatically terminated at the end of the fixed time and the normal radar display is restored. The time of termination depends on the trial mode as follows: Dynamic mode: The trial is terminated when 60 minutes is shown in the Trial Time Box. Static mode: The trial is terminated when there is no key operation within one minute. To terminate the trial maneuver manually, put the cursor in the Trial Time box then push the left button to show TRAIL OFF in the box. Note: To stop the trial maneuver, select OFF at step 5 in the procedure in section 3.16.2. 3-29 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.17 TT Performance Test A test program is provided for assessing overall performance of the TT. Normal operation is suspended and the indication "S" appears at the bottom of the effective display area during the test. The test may be terminated at any time. 1. Right-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 9 [CUSTOMIZE•TEST]. [CUSTOMIZE•TEST] BACK [DATA BOX] [F1] [F2] [F3] [F4] [OPERATION] [TEST] CUSTOMIZE•TEST menu 3. Select 8 [TEST]. [TEST] 1 BACK 2 [SELF TEST] 3 [TT TEST] TEST menu 4. Select 2 TT TEST START] [TT TEST] 1 BACK 2 TT TEST START NOTE: THE DISPLAY IS CLEARER WHEN RUNNING TT TEST. RUN TT TEST? YES: SELECT 2 START NO: SELECT 1 BACK TT TEST menu 3-30 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 5. Select 2 TT TEST START then push the left button to start the test. An alert "S" flickers during the test. Approx. 10 minutes to complete the test scenario. The test does not require echo, gyro or log signals. (Gyro required if TT W/O GYRO setting is OFF. 6. Acquire all three targets. The simulated movement of three targets automatically runs ten minutes and repeats. The courses and speeds for the targets are as shown in the table below. 7. Put the cursor on target A then push the [TARGET DATA] key. Target data appears at the right side of the display. 8. Confirm that test data displayed for target A matches the data shown in the table below. Range, bearing and TCPA change over time. 9. Confirm that data for target B and C. 10. To terminate the test, press the [STBY TX] key, or select the TX STBY box at the bottom left corner then push the left button. Select any target with the cursor and check that the selected target shows the course and speed as in the table. CPA and TCPA shown in the table are with ship’s speed of 0 kn. Range, CPA and TCPA change with time; bearing and speed are fixed. Target A Target B Target C Range (nm) 3.0 2.0 7.0 Bearing Speed (°) (kn) 45.0 20.0 120.0 5.0 270.0 100 Course (°) 120.0 120.0 CPA (nm) 2.1 0.0 3.5 TCPA (min) -6.4 -24.0 3.5 3-31 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.18 Criteria for Selecting Targets for Tracking The FURUNO TT video processor detects targets in midst of noise and discriminates radar echoes on the basis of their size. Target whose echo measurements are greater than those of the largest ship in range or tangential extent are usually land and are displayed only as normal radar video. All smaller ship-sized echoes that are less than this dimension, are further analyzed and regarded as ships and displayed as small circles superimposed over the video echo. When a target is first displayed, it is shown as having zero true speed but develops a course vector as more information is collected. In accordance with the International Marine Organization Automatic Radar Plotting Aid (IMO TT) requirements, an indication of the motion trend should be available within 20 scans of antenna and full vector accuracy within 60 scans. The FURUNO TTs comply with these requirements. Acquisition and tracking A target which is hit by five consecutive radar pulses, is detected as a radar echo. Manual acquisition is done by designating a detected echo with the trackball. Automatic acquisition is done in the acquisition areas when a target is detected 5-7 times continuously depending upon the congestion. Tracking is achieved when the target is clearly distinguishable on the display for 5 out of 10 consecutive scans, whether acquired automatically or manually. Required tracking facilities are available within 0.1-32 nm on range scales including 3, 6, 12 nm, full plotting information is available within one scan when the range scale has been changed. Targets not detected in five consecutive scans become "lost targets." Quantization The entire picture is converted to a digital from called "Quantized Video." A sweep range is divided into small segments and each range element is "1" if there is radar echo return above a threshold level, or "0" if there is no return. The digital radar signal is then analyzed by a ship-sized echo discriminator. As the antenna scans, if there are five consecutive radar pulses with 1’s indicating an echo presence at the exact same range, a target "start" is initiated. Since receiver noise is random, it is not three-bang correlated, and it is filtered out and not classified as an echo. The same is true of radar interference. Electronic circuits track both the closet and most distant edges of the echo. At the end of the scanning of the echo, the discriminator indicates the measured maximum range extent and total angular extent subtended by the echo. If the echo is larger than a ship-sized echo in range extent and/or angular width, adjusted as a function of range, it is declared to be a coastline and the closet edge is put into memory as a map of the area. 3-32 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) This land outline is used to inhibit further acquisition and tracking of ship-sized echoes beyond the closest coast outline. Five consecutive scans of coastal outline are retained in memory to allow for signal variation. All smaller echoes are declared to be ship sized and the middle of the leading edge is used to provide precise range and bearing coordinates of each echo on every scan. This range/bearing data is matched to previous data and analyzed from scan-to-scan for consistency. When it is determined to be as consistent as a real target, automatic acquisition occurs and tracking is initiated. Continued tracking and subsequent calculation develop the relative course and speed of the target. The true course and speed of own ship are computed from own ship's gyro and speed inputs, and the resulting course and speed of each tracked target is easily computed by vector summing of the relative motion with own ship’s course and speed. The resulting true or relative vector is displayed for each of the tracked targets. This process is updated continually for each target on every scan of the radar. Qualitative description of tracking error The FURUNO TT's accuracy complies with or exceed IMO standards. Own ship maneuvers For slow turns there is no effect. For very high turning rates (greater than 150°/minute, depending on gyro), there is some influence on all tracked targets that lasts for a minute or two then all tracked targets revert to full accuracy. Other ship maneuvers Target ship courses, lag 15 to 30 seconds at high relative speed, or 3 to 6 seconds at low (near 0) relative speed. It is less accurate during a turn due to lag, but accuracy recovers quickly. 3-33 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) 3.19 Factors Affecting TT Functions Sea returns If the radar anti-clutter control is adjusted properly, there is no serious effect because distant wave clutter, not eliminated by this control, is filtered out by more than one bang correlation and scan-to-scan matching of data. Rain and snow Clutter can be acquired and tracked as targets. Adjust the A/C RAIN control. If it is heavy rain, switch to S-band if provided, or switch on the interference rejector on the radar. If heavy clutter still exists, switch to manual acquisition. Accuracy can be affected. Low clouds Usually no affect. If necessary, adjust the A/C RAIN control. Non-synchronous emissions No effect. Low gain Insufficient or low radar receiver gain will result in some targets not being acquired at long distance. TT display will be missing on one or more targets that could only be visible if the radar sensitivity control (GAIN control) were increased. The setting of the correct radar receiver gain is not critical but the target should be on the radar PPI and be clearly visible and well defined. Manual acquisition is done if a target is positively displayed more than once. Automatic acquisition is done when the target is detected 5-7 times continuously. Tracking is achieved when the target is detected five times (not necessarily continuously) out of 10 scans. If not detected six times out of 10 scans, the target will become a "lost target." The TT will acquire a radar echo that is present once in every six antenna scans and continue tracking if 1 in 10. Second trace echoes When the radar beam is super refracted, strong echoes may be received at such long ranges that they appear on a different timebase sweep than the transmitted pulse. This gives an incorrect range indication. Second and third trace echoes can be tracked if they are consistent enough to meet acquisition and tracking criteria but target course and speed data will be in error. 3-34 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) Blind and shadow sectors Radar shadow or blind areas caused by obstructions aboard ship, for example, funnels and masts, in the path of the radar beam can result in reduction of radar beam intensity in that particular direction. This may eliminate the detection of some targets. The TT system will lose track of targets shortly after they are lost on the radar picture and if they remain in a blind zone. These targets will however be acquired and tracked when they pass out of the blind zone and again present normal radar echo. The angular width and bearing of any shadow sector should be determined for their influence on the radar. In certain cases false echoes in the shadow sector cause the TT system to acquire, track, and vector them. Shadow sectors should be avoided. Indirect echoes A target at close range is usually picked up directly, but it can also be received as reflection from a large, flat surface. This will result in the radar presenting two or more echoes on the display, each at a different range. The TT can acquire and track the false echo if it is detected by five consecutive scans. Reduction in radar gain can eliminate the multiple echoing but care should be taken as range detection also will be reduced. Radar interference If interference is extreme due to another radar operating at close range, spiral "dotting" and/or false targets may appear momentarily. The interference rejector can clear the display. To receive radar beacon or SART signals, turn on "SART" in the ECHO menu. 3-35 3. TARGET TRACKING (TT) This page is intentionally left blank. 3-36 4. AIS OPERATION The FURUNO AIS (Automatic Identification System) model FA-100 or FA-150 exchanges with other AIS-fitted ships all data and information required by the SOLAS 1994 as amended. However, they are displayed in text form. By interfacing the FA-100 or FA-150 with this radar, the AIS information is graphically indicated together with the radar and TT information. For the IMO specification, position data must be fixed by WGS-84 geodetic datum and speed input must be ground tracking. If other type of datum is input, the error message "DATUM" appears and the AIS feature is inoperative. This restriction does not apply to other types. When AIS is active, MANUAL and REF in the speed source selection window are shown in gray to indicate they are not available for selection. You may disable or enable the AIS display from the AIS DISP box. Controls for AIS Keyboard The AIS uses the keys shown below. POWER BRILL OFF A/C RAIN A/C SEA GAIN ON EBL OFF ON HL OFF EBL OFFSET MODE F1 F2 OFF CENTER CU/TM RESET INDEX LINE F3 F4 VECTOR TIME VECTOR MODE TARGET LIST ALARM ACK STBY TX CANCEL TRAILS ENTER BRILL MARK VRM MENU ACQ TARGET DATA RANGE 4.1 TARGET CANCEL TARGET DATA: Displays data on AIS target selected by the trackball. TARGET CANCEL: Sleeps chosen AIS target. Control unit RCU-014 Trackball With the cursor inside the effective display area, you can access AIS functions by rolling the scrollwheel or choosing appropriate AIS function from the CURSOR menu. Roll the scrollwheel to show the following indications in the guidance box to access respective AIS function: TARGET DATA & ACQ: Displays target data for AIS target selected with the trackball; activates chosen AIS target. TARGET CANCEL: Sleeps selected AIS activated target. 4-1 4. AIS OPERATION 4.2 Showing, Hiding the AIS Display Left-click the AIS DISP box at the right side of the screen to show or hide the AIS display and set display criteria. DISP ALL: All AIS targets received from the AIS transponder are displayed with symbols. DISP FILT: AIS targets are displayed according to the criteria set with AIS DISP FILTER on the AIS/TT menu. See section 4.3 for details. DISP OFF: All AIS symbols disappear, but tracking continues internally. AIS DISP OFF AIS DISP box When the AIS is turned on, AIS targets are marked with appropriate AIS symbol as below. SYMBOL STATUS REMARKS Activated target All AIS symbols shown with thick line. Color is selectable from menu. ROT higher than preset ROT Displayed for turning ship. Dangerous target Displayed when CPA/TCPA is within CPA/TCPA LIMIT. Red in color. Flashing .until acknowledged. Lost target “X” overlaid on a lost target. Red in color. Erased after acknowledged. Target selected Broken square is overlaid on target for data display selected to display its data. A, B or C shown to indicate data box location (at the right side of the screen). AIS symbols Note 1: The equipment continues to process AIS targets when the AIS feature is switched off. When the AIS is again turned on, symbols are immediately displayed. Note 2: You can turn the AIS display off by putting the cursor in the AIS box and long-pushing the left button to show FUNC OFF. Data processing is terminated. Note 3: AIS symbols are momentarily erased and the screen is redrawn after the heading is changed in the head-up mode. Note 4: When no AIS data is received, the message "RECEIVE" appears in the Alert Box. Check the AIS transponder. 4-2 4. AIS OPERATION Note 5: AIS symbols are shown in dotted lines in the following cases: - No water or ground tracking speed of your ship, or there is no speed data. All AIS symbols are shown in dotted lines and the message "NO CPA/TCPA for AIS" appears (in red) in the Alert Box. - No water or ground tracking speed received from AIS target, or no speed data from AIS target. The symbol of the corresponding AIS target is shown in dotted lines. Note 6: Other AIS symbols that may appear are shown in the table below. Symbol Meaning Real AIS AtoN Virtual AIS AtoN Base Station Airborne SAR aircraft AIS SART Note 7: The CPA and TCPA of SAR aircraft data are not available, and are shown as ***. 4-3 4. AIS OPERATION 4.3 AIS Display Filter If there are too many AIS targets on the screen you may wish to remove unnecessary ones. You may remove targets by distance from own ship, speed, class and length. For example, you might want to remove slow moving targets, as they normally do not require close monitoring. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 4 [TT●AIS] to open the TT●AIS menu. [TT•AIS MENU] 1 BACK 2 AZ STAB STAB HDG/STAB NORTH 3 AZ POLYGON OFF/STAB GND/ STAB HDG/STAB NORTH 4 [TRIAL MANEUVER] 5 [TT AIS SYMBOL] 6 [CPA AUTO ACTIVATE] 7 [AIS DISP FILTER] 8 [AIS LOST FILTER] 9 [TT LOST FILTER] 0 [ASSOCIATION] TT/AIS menu 3. Select 7 [AIS DISP FILTER]. [AIS DISP FILTER] 1 BACK 2 MAX RANGE OFF/ON 0NM 3 MIN SHIP SPEED OFF/ON 0.0kn 4 EXCEPT CLASS B OFF/ON 5 MIN SHIP LENGTH OFF/ON 0M If the AIS DISP box is operated when all settings on this menu are set for OFF, the setting of the AIS DISP box becomes DISP ALL. AIS DISP FILTER menu 4. Set items 2-5 referring to the description below. MAX RANGE: Any AIS target beyond the range set here will not be shown. MIN SHIP SPEED: Any AIS target slower than this setting will not be shown. EXCEPT CLASS B: Select ON to remove Class B AIS targets. MIN SHIP LENGTH: Any AIS target whose length is shorter than this setting will not be shown. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 6. Select "DISP FILT" from the AIS DISP box. Note: An AIS target whose data is currently displayed is not affected by the filter setting. 4-4 4. AIS OPERATION 4.4 Activating Targets When you convert a sleeping target to an activated target, that target’s course and speed are shown with a vector. You can easily judge target movement by monitoring the vector. Sleeping targets within an acquisition zone are automatically changed to activated targets and are colored red. See section 3.14 for details. 4.4.1 Activating specific targets manually By keyboard 1. Use the trackball to put the cursor on the AIS target you wish activate. 2. Press the [TARGET DATA] key to activate the target. By trackball 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to display "TARGET DATA & ACQ / CURSOR MENU" in the guidance box. 2. Use the trackball to put the cursor on the sleeping AIS target you wish to activate; that is, know more about a vessel’s motion. 3. Push the left button to activate the target. SOG (Speed over Ground) and COG (Course over Ground) vector *1 Turning direction (ROT) Heading line *2 *2 If there is no heading data, the line points in direction of COG. *1 Vector shows STW (speed thru water) and CSE (course) when water tracking mode is selected at the radar. Activated target 4.4.2 Activating all targets 1. Right-click the AIS DISP box to open the AIS TARGET menu. 2. Select 2 ACTIVATE ALL TRGTS. 3. Push the right button to close the menu. Dangerous target When an activated target violates the CPA/TCPA alarm setting its symbol changes to the dangerous target symbol (red and flashing) and the indication AIS COLLISON appears. Press the [ALARM ACK] key (or click the ALARM ACK box with the left button) to acknowledge the CPA/TCPA alarm. The audible alarm is silenced and the symbol stops flashing. Take appropriate action to avoid collision. Thicker than activated target 4-5 4. AIS OPERATION 4.5 How to Sleep Targets 4.5.1 Sleeping an individual target You may "sleep" an AIS target as below when the screen becomes filled with targets, which might prevent important radar and AIS displays from being identified. Note that targets that have been activated automatically cannot be "slept." 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to display "TARGET CANCEL / EXIT" in the guidance box. 2. Use the trackball to put the cursor on an activated AIS target symbol. 3. Push the left button. The activated target symbol is replaced with the sleeping target symbol. Sleeping target 4.5.2 Sleeping all targets 1. Right-click the AIS DISP box to open the AIS TARGET menu. [AIS TARGET MENU] 1 SLEEP ALL TRGTS NO/YES 2 ACTIVATE ALL TRGTS NO/YES 3 AUTO DISP MESSAGES OFF/ON 4 [RECEIVED MESSAGES] 5 [TRANSMIT MESSAGE] 6 [VOYAGE DATA] 7 [STATIC DATA] 8 [AIS ALM MESSAGES] AIS TARGET menu 2. Select 1 SLEEP ALL TRGTS. 3. Select YES to sleep all AIS targets. 4. Push the right button to close the menu. 4-6 4. AIS OPERATION 4.6 Setting Up for a Voyage There are five items on the VOYAGE DATA menu you will need to enter at the start of a voyage: navigational status, ETA, destination, draught and crew. 1. Right-click the AIS DISP box at the right side of the screen to open the AIS TARGET menu. [AIS TARGET MENU] 1 SLEEP ALL TRGTS NO/YES 2 ACTIVATE ALL TRGTS NO/YES 3 AUTO DISP MESSAGES OFF/ON 4 [RECEIVED MESSAGES] 5 [TRANSMIT MESSAGE] 6 [VOYAGE DATA] 7 [STATIC DATA] 8 [AIS ALM MESSAGES] AIS TARGET menu 2. Select 6 VOYAGE DATA. [VOYAGE DATA] 1 BACK 2 NAVIGATION STATUS 03 RESTRICTED MANOEVRABILITY 3 ETA 00/000/0000 00:00 4 DESTINATION 12 5 DRAUGHT 00.0m 6 CREW 0002 VOYAGE DATA menu 3. Select 2 NAVIGATION STATUS. 4-7 4. AIS OPERATION 4. Select appropriate navigation status number referring to the information below then push left button. 00: 01: 02: 03: 04: 05: 06: 07: 08: 09: 10: 11-13: 14: 15: Underway using engine (default) At anchor Not under command Restricted manoeuverability Constrained by her draft Moored Aground Engaged in fishing Under way sailing Reserved for high speed craft (HSC) Reserved for wing in ground (WIG, for example, hydrofoil) Reserved for future use AIS SART (No use) Not defined 5. Select 3 ETA then push the left button. 6. Use the scrollwheel to enter estimated date and time of arrival, in order of day (two digits), month, year (four digits) and time. Push the scrollwheel after entering the data. 7. Select 4 DESTINATION. 8. Enter destination: Select alphanumeric character, push the scrollwheel to enter. 9. Select 5 DRAUGHT. 10. Roll the scrollwheel to set ship’s draught (setting range: 0-25.5 m) then push the scrollwheel. 11. Select 6 CREW. 12. Roll the scrollwheel to set number of crew (0–8191) then push the scrollwheel. 13. Push the right button to close the menu. 4-8 4. AIS OPERATION 4.7 Target Data You may display an AIS target’s data by selecting it on the display, when the AIS function is set for "AIS DISP FILT". 4.7.1 Basic target data By keyboard 1. Use the trackball to put the cursor on the AIS target symbol you want to know its data. 2. Press the [TARGET DATA] key. By trackball 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to display "TARGET DATA & ACQ / CURSOR MENU". 2. Use the trackball to put the cursor on an AIS target symbol. The selected target is marked with a broken square and AIS data is shown in the AIS data box when the target is correctly selected. Location of target’s data box. Not shown on W-type radar. Activated target selected for data display Location of target data, MMSI No. Name of ship Bearing to target Range to target Target's course Target's speed Target's CPA Target's TCPA Target's bow cross range Target's bow cross time AIS B MMSI 665498114 VOYAGER 34°37.912 N BRG 208.6°T 135°21.569 E RNG 12.3NM NAV-STATUS TCOG 9.0°T* UNDER WAY USING ENGINE TSOG 8.2kn# CPA 5.32NM TCPA 33:31 BCR 5.65NM BCT 25:30 HDG 048.0°T 0.0°/min Position Nav status Heading Rate of turn * = CSE (course) when water tracking mode is selected at radar. # = STW (speed thru water) when water tracking mode is selected at radar. AIS data display 4-9 4. AIS OPERATION 4.7.2 Detailed target data 1. Use the trackball to put the cursor on the desired AIS target in the data box at the right side of the screen. 2. Push the left button to show detailed data. [EXPANDED DATA] Ship's name Call sign Latitude Longitude Position fixing device Position accuracy (HIGH, LOW) Navigation status MMSI No. IMO No. Length Width Draft Destination Estimated Time of Arrival AIS program no. Assocation ON/OFF Type of ship and cargo NAME: VOYAGER CALL: WRE45T LAT: 34 °44.2345'N LON: 135°32.1890'E POS. SENSOR GPS POS. ACC.: HIGH NAV. STATUS UNDERWAY USING ENGINE MMSI No.: 107374182 IMO No.: 123544876 SHIP LENGTH: 55m SHIP WIDTH: 15m SHIP DRAFT: 2.8m DESTINATION KOBE ETA: 01/FEB 12:59 AIS VERSION: 0 ASSOCIATION: OFF SHIP & CARGO TYPE: CARGO SHIPS ALL SHIPS OF THIS TYPE Expanded data 4.7.3 Removing a target data display Put the cursor on the data you want to remove and hit the [TARGET DATA] key. 4.7.4 Canceling tracking on a target from target data display Put the cursor on the target you want to stop tracking and hit the [TARGET CANCEL] key. 4-10 4. AIS OPERATION 4.8 AIS Symbol Attributes You may adjust the brilliance and select the size and color of the AIS symbol. 4.8.1 AIS symbol brilliance 1. Right-click the BRILL box at the left side of the screen. 2. Select 0 NEXT. [BRILL1 MENU (2/2)] BACK BRG CURSOR EBL VRM PI LINE TT SYMBOL AIS SYMBOL L/L GRID MARK CHART* * Not available on IMO type BRILL menu, page 2 3. Select 7 AIS SYMBOL. 4. Roll the scrollwheel to adjust brilliance. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 4.8.2 AIS symbol size and color You may select the size and color of the AIS symbol as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 4 [TT/AIS]. 3. Select 5 [TT/AIS SYMBOL]. [TT.AIS SYMBOL] 1 BACK 2 TT.AIS SYMBOL COLOR RED*/GRN/BLU/YEL*/ CYA/MAG/WHT 3 AIS ROT TAG LIMIT 000.0˚/min 4 TT PAST POSN POINTS 5/10 5 AIS PAST POSN POINTS 5/10 6 AIS SCALED SYMBOL OFF/ON * Not available on IMO type AIS SYMBOL menu 4. Select 2 TT•AIS SYMBOL COLOR. 5. Select color desired. 4-11 4. AIS OPERATION 6. Select 6 AIS SCALED SYMBOL. 7. Select OFF or ON as applicable. OFF: All AIS symbols shown in same size. ON: All AIS symbols are scaled according to ships' lengths. 8. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 4.9 Past Position Display The past position display shows equally time-spaced dots marking past positions of activated AIS targets. A new dot is added at preset time intervals until the preset number is reached. If a target changes its speed, the spacing will be uneven. If it changes course, its plotted course will not be a straight line. Note that AIS past positions will be shown if TARGET TRACK on the DISPLAY sub menu of the PLOTTER menu is ON, regardless of whether AUTO TARGET TRACK on the PLOTTER menu is turned ON or OFF. Below are sample past position displays. (a) Ship turning (b) Ship running straight (c) Ship reduced speed (d) Ship increased speed Sample past position displays 4.9.1 Past position plot interval Left-click the PAST POSN box at the right side of the screen to select plot interval desired: OFF, 30 s, 1, 2, 3 or 6 min. Select OFF to erase all past position points and turn off the past position display. PAST POSN REL 2MIN PAST POSN box 4-12 4. AIS OPERATION 4.9.2 Past position points You may select the number of past position points to show per plot interval as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 4 [TT/AIS] to open the TT AIS menu. 3. Select 5 [TT/AIS SYMBOL]. [TT.AIS SYMBOL] 1 BACK 2 TT.AIS SYMBOL COLOR RED*/GRN/BLU/YEL*/ CYA/MAG/WHT 3 AIS ROT TAG LIMIT 000.0˚/min 4 TT PAST POSN POINTS 5/10 5 AIS PAST POSN POINTS 5/10 6 AIS SCALED SYMBOL OFF/ON * Not available on IMO type AIS SYMBOL menu 4. Select 5 AIS PAST POSN POINTS. 5. Select 5 or 10 as appropriate. 6. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 4.9.3 Past position display motion The past position display may be shown in true or relative motion. Open the TRAIL menu and set TRAIL MODE to TRUE or RELATIVE as appropriate. 4.9.4 Stabilization in true motion The true motion past position display may be ground stabilized or sea stabilized. The PAST POSN box shows current stabilization as TRUE-G or TRUE-S. To change the stabilization mode, open the SPEED menu and set SHIP SPEED to BT (ground stabilization) or WT (sea stabilization). 4-13 4. AIS OPERATION 4.10 Lost Target A target is declared a lost target when it fails to produce data for six minutes or five reporting intervals, whichever is the shorter. When this occurs, the target is marked with the (flashing) lost target symbol and the indication "LOST" appears in the Alert Box. To acknowledge a lost target, press the [ALARM ACK] key, or use the trackball to select the ALARM ACK box then push the left button. Lost target Note 1: If a TT lost target mark is displayed when the [ALARM ACK] key is pressed (or the ALARM ACK box is clicked) to acknowledge an AIS lost target, the TT lost target also is erased. Note 2: The AIS data transmission interval depends on target’s speed. For example, the data is transmitted every 10 seconds on ship speed of 0 to 14 knots and every two seconds on the ship speed of more than 23 knots. For details see the owner’s manual of the AIS. 4.10.1 Lost target filter If there are a lot of AIS targets in your area, the lost target alarm may sound frequently. In this case you may wish to have the alarm ignore lost targets whose range, speed, class or length are below the threshold value you specify. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 4 [TT●AIS] to open the TT AIS menu. 3. Select 8 [AIS LOST FILTER]. [AIS LOST FILTER] 1 BACK 2 MAX RANGE OFF/ON 0NM 4 MIN SHIP SPEED OFF/ON 0.1kn 5 EXCEPT CLASS B OFF/ON 5 MIN SHIP LENGTH OFF/ON 0M AIS LOST FILTER menu 4-14 4. AIS OPERATION 4. Set items 2-5 as appropriate, referring the description below. MAX RANGE: Any AIS lost targets beyond this range will not trigger the lost target alarm. MIN SHIP SPEED: Any AIS lost targets slower than this setting will not trigger the lost target alarm. EXCEPT CLASS B: Select ON to prevent trigger lost B class AIS lost target. MIN SHIP LENGTH: Any AIS lost targets whose length is shorter than this setting will not trigger the lost target alarm. 5. Push the right button several times to close the menu. 4.10.2 Enabling, disabling the lost target alarm The LOST TARGET ALARM box at the bottom right corner enables and disables the lost target alarm. Select OFF, ALL or FILT as appropriate. OFF: Disable the alarm. ALL: Get the alarm against all lost targets. FILT: Get the alarm against the AIS targets whose criteria meet the settings on the AIS LOST FILTER menu. CPA AUTO ACTIVATE OFF CPA AUTO ACTIVATE box 4-15 4. AIS OPERATION 4.11 ROT Setting You may set the lower limit of the ROT (Rate Of Turn) at which the heading line on target symbols will point in direction of turning of the vessel. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 4 [TT/AIS] to open the TT/AIS menu. [TT.AIS SYMBOL] 1 BACK 2 TT.AIS SYMBOL COLOR RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT 3 AIS ROT TAG LIMIT 000.1˚/min 4 TT PAST POSN POINTS 5/10 5 AIS PAST POSN POINTS 5/10 6 AIS SCALED SYMBOL OFF/ON AIS SYMBOL menu 3. Select 3 AIS ROT TAG LIMIT. 4. Use the numeral keys or the scrollwheel to enter ROT (setting range: 0.1 to 720.0 (°/min)). 5. Push the right button three times to close the menu. Ship turning to starboard ROT display 4-16 4. AIS OPERATION 4.12 AIS Collision Alarm (CPA, TCPA) The AIS continuously monitors the predicted range at the Closest Point of Approach (CPA) and predicted time to CPA (TCPA) of each AIS target. When the predicted CPA of an AIS target becomes smaller than a preset CPA range and its predicted TCPA less than a preset TCPA limit, the audio alarm sounds and AIS COLLISION appears (in red) in the Alert Box. In addition, the symbol of the offending AIS target is red and flashes together with its vector. CPA/TCPA alarm ranges must be set up properly taking into consideration the size, tonnage, speed, turning performance and other characteristics of own ship. The reference point for CPA, TCPA calculation may be selected from antenna position or conning position. For further details, see section 1.50. 4.12.1 Setting the CPA and TCPA ranges To set the CPA and TCPA ranges, do the following: 1. Left-click CPA LIMIT box to show the CPA and TCPA boxes. (Not necessary if the CPA and TCPA boxes are already shown.) CPA LIMIT Box CPA LIMIT CPA Box 0.5NM 10MIN TCPA Box CPA LIMIT, CPA and TCPA boxes 2. Select the CPA Box. 3. Push the left button or scrollwheel to select CPA value. Left button 0.5, 1, 1.5, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6(nm) Scrollwheel 0.1-20(nm), 0-10 nm in 0.1 nm increments, 10 nm increments thereafter 4. Select the TCPA box. 5. Push the left button or scrollwheel to select TCPA value. Left button 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 12, 15(minutes) Scrollwheel 1-60 minutes, 1-minute increment 4.12.2 Enabling, disabling the AIS collision alarm Use the CPA AUTO ACTIVATE box at the bottom right corner to enable or disable the AIS collision alarm. OFF: Disable automatic activation. ALL: Activation against AIS targets whose CPA or TCPA is less than set in section 4.12.1. FILT: Alarm is given against AIS targets which meet the following criteria: - AIS target that meets the criteria set with 6 CPA AUTO ACTIVATE on the TT●AIS menu. - CPA or TCPA of an AIS target is smaller than that set in section 4.12.1 4-17 4. AIS OPERATION CPA AUTO ACTIVATE OFF CPA AUTO ACTIVATE box 4.12.3 Limiting the function of the collision alarm You can limit the function of the collision alarm by distance from own ship, ship's speed, ship class, and ship's length. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Choose 4 TT●AIS. 3. Choose 6 [CPA AUTO ACTIVATE]. [CPA AUTO ACTIVATE] 1 BACK 2 MAX RANGE OFF/ON 0NM 3 MIN SHIP SPEED OFF/ON 0.0KN 4 EXCEPT CLASS B OFF/ON 5 MIN SHIP LENGTH OFF/ON 0M CPA AUTO ACTIVATE menu 4. Set items 2-5 as appropriate. MAX RANGE: MIN SHIP SPEED: EXCEPT CLASS B: MIN SHIP LENGTH: Any AIS target beyond this range will not be automatically activated. Any AIS targets slower than this setting will not be automatically activated. Select ON to prevent automatic activation of class B AIS targets. Any AIS targets whose length is shorter than this setting will not be automatically activated. 5. Push the right button several times to close the menu. 4-18 4. AIS OPERATION 4.13 Association of TT and AIS Targets If the target data from AIS and TT are both available, and if the association criteria (for example position, motion) are fulfilled such that the AIS and TT are considered as one physical target, the activated AIS (or TT) target symbol and the alphanumeric AIS (or TT) target data is automatically selected and displayed. If the AIS and radar information become sufficiently different, the AIS and radar information shall be considered as two distinct targets. One activated AIS target and one tracked radar target shall be displayed. 1. 2. 3. 4. Confirm that the TT ACQ MODE box shows AUTO, AUTO MAN or MAN. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 4 [TT●AIS] to open the TT/AIS menu. Select 0 [ASSOCIATION] to show the ASSOCATION menu, shown right. [ASSOCIATION] 1 BACK 2 ASSOCIATION TARGET OFF/AIS/TT 3 GAP 0.050NM 4 RANGE 0.100NM 5 BEARING 9.9° 6 SPEED 6.0kn 7 COURSE 25.0° 5. Select ASSOCIATION TARGET. 6. Select OFF, AIS or TT as applicable to select which symbols and data to show when association criteria is met. OFF: Turn off association. AIS: Use AIS symbols and AIS data. TT: Use TT symbols and TT data. 4-19 4. AIS OPERATION Note: Association can also be switched on and off from the screen by left-clicking the Association Usage icon, shown below. Association Usage >: Use TT symbols and data <: Use AIS symbols and data No indication: Assocation OFF TT OFF DISP AIS FILT VECTOR REL PAST POSN REL CPA LIMIT 0. 5NM CPA AUTO ACTIVATE LOST TARGET ALARM 30M 3M 22MIN OFF OFF TARGET CURSOR DATA & ACQ MENU 7. Enter the information below, pushing the scrollwheel (or the [MARK ENTER] key) after entering each data. This information will be used to determine which tracked targets to convert. GAP: RANGE: BEARING: SPEED: COURSE: Enter the range in bearing direction between AIS target and tracked target. (setting range: 0.000-0.999(nm)) Enter the range direction difference from own ship to AIS target and tracked target. (setting range: 0.000-0.999(nm)) Enter the bearing difference from own ship to AIS target and tracked target. (setting range: 0.0-99.9(°)) Enter the speed difference between AIS target and tracked target. (setting range: 0.0-9.9(kn)) Enter the course difference between AIS target and tracked target. (setting range: 0.0-99.9(°)) 8. Push the right button three times to close the menu. When the association criteria (gap, range, bearing, speed, and course) is met, and the ASSOCIATION TARGET setting is "AIS," the TT symbol is erased and only the AIS symbol is displayed. Further, "ASSOCIATION" appears in the Alert Box. All default association settings are restored whenever the power is turned on. 4-20 4. AIS OPERATION 4.14 Own Ship’s Data Own ship’s static data (type of ship, call sign, name and position of internal and external GPS antennas) can be viewed as follows 1. Right-click the AIS DISP box at the right side of the screen to open the AIS TARGET menu. 2. Select 7 STATIC DATA. [STATIC DATA] 1 BACK TYPE OF SHIP 000 ALL SHIPS OF THIS TYPE CALL SIGN (call sign here) NAME (ship name here) EXT GPS ANT POSN A: 000m B: 000m C: 00m D: 00m STATIC DATA menu 3. Push the right button to close the menu. 4-21 4. AIS OPERATION 4.15 Messages You may transmit and receive messages via the AIS, to a specified destination (MMSI) or all ships in the area. Messages can be sent to warn of safety of navigation, for example, an iceberg sighted. Routine messages are also permitted. Short safety related messages are only an additional means to broadcast safety information. They do not remove the requirements of the GMDSS. 4.15.1 Creating, saving messages This section shows you how to create and save a message. Nine messages may be saved. Note: You can display the TRANSMIT MESSAGE menu and set ship's MMSI no. by right-clicking the appropriate AIS target in the AIS target data display. 1. Right click the AIS DISP box. 2. Select 5 TRANSMIT MESSAGE. [TRANSMIT MESSAGE] 1 BACK 2 ADDRESS TYPE ADDRESSED/BROADCAST 3 MESSAGE TYPE SAFETY/BINARY 4 MMSI No. 000000000 5 CHANNEL A/B/A or B/A and B 6 OPEN FILE 1 7 SAVE FILE 1 8 EDIT 9 TRANSMIT MESSAGE 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 4-22 TRANSMIT MESSAGE menu Select 2 ADDRESS TYPE. Select ADDRESSED (message for specific MMSI) or BROADCAST (message to all AIS-equipped vessels in area). Select 3 MESSAGE TYPE. Select SAFETY for safety message or BINARY for routine message. For ADDRESSED message, do this step. For BROADCAST message, go to step 9. 1) Select 4 MMSI NO. 2) Use the scrollwheel to enter ship’s MMSI no.: Select alphanumeric character then push the scrollwheel. Select 5 CHANNEL. Select the AIS channel to transmit your message over: A, B, A or B, or A and B. Push the scrollwheel after making your selection. 4. AIS OPERATION 10. Select 8 EDIT and push the scroll wheel or left button. A mini keyboard appears at the bottom of the menu. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 BS Q W E R T Y U I O P > A S D F G H J K L + = Z X C V B N M , . ? END ” # / Space Mini keyboard 11. Use the trackball to select character desired then push the left button. Repeat to enter message. The maximum number of characters allowable is as follows: ADDRESSED BINARY: 151 ADDRESSED SAFETY: 156 BROADCAST BINARY: 156 BROADCAST SAFETY: 161 12. Select END then push the left button. 13. Select 7 SAVE FILE. 14. Select appropriate number. 15. Push the right button to close the menu. 4.15.2 Transmitting messages 1. Right-click the AIS DISP box at the right side of the screen. 2. Do one of the following: a) Create a message as described in section 4.14.1. b) Use a file saved in the memory by choosing 5 TRANSMIT MESSAGE followed by 6 OPEN FILE. 3. Select 9 TRANSMIT MESSAGE to transmit the message. 4. Push the right button to send the message and close the menu. "AIS TRANSMITTING" appears while the message is being transmitted. "TRANSMIT ERROR" appears if a message could not be transmitted. 4-23 4. AIS OPERATION 4.15.3 Viewing messages When an AIS message is received, the display shows an appropriate icon to alert you. If you are set up to automatically display AIS messages they are automatically displayed upon receipt. The system stores up to 20 AIS messages. When the storage capacity is reached the oldest AIS message is automatically erased to make room for the latest. Note that received messages and alarm messages are not backed up when the power is turned off. Manually viewing received messages To view received AIS messages do the following: 1. Right-click the AIS DISP box at the right side of the display. [AIS TARGET MENU] 1 SLEEP ALL TRGTS NO/YES 2 ACTIVATE ALL TRGTS NO/YES 3 AUTO DISP MESSAGES OFF/ON 4 [RECEIVED MESSAGES] 5 [TRANSMIT MESSAGE] 6 [VOYAGE DATA] 7 [STATIC DATA] 8 [AIS ALM MESSAGES] AIS TARGET menu 2. Select 4 RECEIVED MESSAGES. (Up to five received messages are displayed.) [RECEIVED MESSAGES] (1/1) 1 BACK [L = TOP] 2 09DEC2003 12:34 ADDRESSED SAFETY MMSI: 107374182 RECEIVED MESSAGES menu 4-24 4. AIS OPERATION 3. Select the message which you want to see. NAME: FURUNO CALL: 112233 STORM WARNING VICINITY OF 35°N 135°W Example of received AIS message (max. 180 characters) 4. Push the right button several times to close the message and the menu. Displaying messages You can display AIS messages upon receipt as follows: 1. 2. 3. 4. Right-click the AIS DISP box. Select 3 AUTO DISP MESSAGES. Select ON. Push the right button to close the menu. When a message arrives the message arrival icon ( ) appears at the right-hand side of the display. Click the icon with the left button to show the message. Viewing alarm messages The transponder outputs various alarm messages. You can view them as follows: 1. 2. 3. 4. Right-click the AIS DISP box. Select 8 AIS ALM MESSAGES. Select the date display of alarm you want to view. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 4-25 4. AIS OPERATION 4.16 AIS System Messages AIS system messages are displayed at the bottom right corner of the screen. The table below shows the AIS system messages and their meanings. AIS system messages Message AIS COLLISION AIS NEW TARGET AIS LOST AIS TARGET 95% AIS TARGET FULL ASSOCIATION NO CPA/TCPA FOR AIS RECEIVE TRANSMIT ERROR WT 4-26 Meaning CPA and TCPA of an activated AIS target are below value set on the menu. AIS target has entered an acquisition zone. Lost target. An activated target is declared a lost target when it fails to produce data for six minutes or five reporting intervals, whichever is the shorter. Appears when capacity for AIS targets is 95% full. The radar only displays the closest 1000 AIS targets from own ship. Tracked target merged with AIS target. The indication disappears when the target no longer meets the criteria set in section 4.12. When the message "RECEIVE" is displayed, ASSOCIATION is not displayed. CPA/TCPA cannot be calculated. Further the CPA/TCPA value in the basic data display is marked with an asterisk to indicate that it is not reliable. Not receiving AIS data from own AIS (VDO message). Could not send AIS message. Water tracking speed in use. 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.1 General The video plotter does the following functions: • Plots own and other ships’ tracks. (Plotting of other ships’ tracks not available on IMO type.) • Enters waypoints, nav lines and marks. • Creates and displays radar maps. • Records data onto memory cards (optional card interface required). • It uses two types of memory cards, a memory card (RAM card) for storing own ship and other ship’s tracks and marks, and a digital chart card (ROM card). • 30 nav lines may be stored and each line may contain up to 30 waypoints. One nav line may be shown on the display. 200 waypoints are available. Own ship and other ship tracks may be stored at a selected interval. • Charts (A, B, C and W types) are superimposed on the radar picture without disturbing the radar observation. The chart area is dependent on the radar range in use. 5.2 Display Modes This radar has display modes as follows. • IMO, A type: Radar, Radar + Plotter, Anchor Watch • B, C, W type: Radar, Radar + Plotter, Plotter Use the DISPLAY MODE box to select a mode. (When the video plotter mode is displayed more than five seconds, the radar automatically goes into standby.) Note 1: Display mode cannot be selected when the menu is open. Close the menu to select a display mode. Note 2: IMO type radar can display own ship’s track and L/L grid on the +PLOTTER display. Note 3: The anchor watch, as well as AIS, is active in standby. 5-1 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION Sample video plotter display Past position (AIS and TT) Separation zone Waypoint Navline Tracked Target (TT) W012 Own ship safe contour Planned route Heading line AIS activated target Own ship vector Approximate coastline Dangerous side of own ship safe contour may look like this (hatched line) Video plotter display 5.3 Presentation Modes Five presentation modes are available: North-up, Course-up, Head-up, Head-up TB (True Bearing) Stern-up and North-up TM (True Motion). To select a mode, use the [MODE] key or select the PRESENTATION MODE box then push the left button. For a description of the presentation modes, see section 1.12. Note 1: Chart data is not displayed on the HEAD UP and HEAD UP TB modes. Note 2: The screen may flash when the heading is changed more than one degree in the HEAD UP or HEAD UP TB mode. Automatic resetting of own ship mark in true motion mode In the true motion mode, the own ship mark is automatically returned sternward 75% from the screen center when it reaches a location 50% of the display radius. 5-2 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.4 Radar Map A radar map is a combination of map lines and symbols whereby the user can define and input the navigation data, route planning and monitoring data. The radar map may contain 20,000 points of data. The map data can be saved to facilitate repeated use on a routine navigation area. The user can create a radar map on-real time while using the radar for navigation or at leisure time at anchor or while the radar is not being used. Place of a map can be made for any waterways apart from the actual own ship location. The radar map does not affect any radar function. 5.4.1 Showing, hiding the radar map display From menu 1. Use the trackball to select the MARK box. 2. Push the right button to open the MARK menu. [MARK MENU] 1 ORIGIN MARK STAB GND/SEA 2 MARK KIND ORIGIN MARK(No. )/ ORIGIN MARK(SYM)/ MAP MARK/ WP 1~50/ WP 51~ 100/ WP 101~150/ WP 151~198/ OWN SHIP SHAPE 8 MARK POSN CURSOR/OS/L/L 00°000.00 N 000°000.00 E 9 MAP DISPLAY OFF/ON 0 MAP MARK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT * Not available on IMO or A type MARK menu 3. Select 9 MAP DISPLAY. 4. Select ON or OFF as applicable. 5. Push the right button to close the menu. From mark legend MARK > MAP ON Place cursor on text and left-click to hide and show map alternately. 5-3 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.4.2 Inscribing radar map marks and lines 1. Use the trackball to select the MARK box at the left side of the display. MARK > Mark type MARK box 2. Push the right button to open the MARK menu. [MARK MENU] 1 ORIGIN MARK STAB GND/SEA 2 MARK KIND ORIGIN MARK(No. )/ ORIGIN MARK(SYM)/ MAP MARK/ WP 1~50/ WP 51~ 100/ WP 101~150/ WP 151~198/ OWN SHIP SHAPE 8 MARK POSN CURSOR/OS/L/L 00°000.00 N 000°000.00 E 9 MAP DISPLAY OFF/ON 0 MAP MARK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT * Not available on IMO or A type MARK menu 3. Select 2 MARK KIND. 4. Select MAP MARK. Note 1: For other than IMO- and A-type radars you may specify mark color by choosing 0 MAP MARK COLOR, pushing the scrollwheel then choosing color desired. Note 2: On the W-type, the indication "MAP" appears to the right of the MARK box. 5. Push the right button to close the menu. The guidance box now reads "MARK SELECT / MARK MENU." 6. With the cursor choosing the MARK box, use the scrollwheel to select the mark or line type you wish to inscribe then push the left button. See the next page for available marks. The cursor jumps into the effective display area and the guidance box now reads "MARK / EXIT." 7. Select 8 MARK POSN. 8. Select mark entry method, CURSOR, OS or L/L. For L/L, enter position. 9. For cursor, use the trackball to put the cursor on the location desired. (You can see the range and bearing from own ship to the cursor location by monitoring the bearing and range indication just below the MARK box.) Push the left button to inscribe the mark or line point. 5-4 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION • To continue entering the same mark or line (with the guidance box showing "MARK / EXIT"), use the trackball to select location then push the left button. • To quit entering marks or lines, push the right button when the guidance box reads "MARK / EXIT." B, C and W types (seven colors available) Item on DISPLAY menu* Mark Danger Highlight Buoy Red Green Red Item on DISPLAY menu* Buoy Buoy Buoy Buoy Green Buoy Buoy Red Buoy Buoy Green Buoy Buoy Red Buoy Danger Highlight Green Buoy Mark Mark (cable) (w/line) (w/line) (w/line) (w/line) IMO and A types Mark Mark Mark Mark Mark Nav Line (map) Coastline Contour Prohibited Area Danger Highlight Buoy Mark Mark Mark Purple Purple Orange Orange Orange Purple White Gray Purple Purple (cable) Orange Orange Danger Highlight Danger Highlight Mark Mark Mark Navline (map) Coastline Contour Line Danger Highlight Danger Highlight Mark Mark * The graphics on the DISPLAY menu can shown or hidden. PAGE 1: 5 MARK, 8 COASTLINE, 9 CONTOUR LINE PAGE 2: 2 NAVLINE, 3 DANGER HIGHLIGHT, 4 PROHIBITED AREA, 5 BUOY Note: Any inscribed mark or graphic is retained when the power is turned off. 5-5 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.5 Erasing Radar Map Marks and Lines A total of 20,000 points is allotted for radar map marks and lines. When this amount is exceeded, no more map marks or lines may be entered unless you erase unnecessary marks or lines. 5.5.1 Erasing individual radar map marks and lines 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to show "MARK DELETE / EXIT" in the guidance box. 2. Use the trackball to put the cursor on the radar map mark or line you wish to erase. 3. Push the left button to erase selected mark or line. Note: When erasing a line, the cursor location determines how the line will be erased. To erase a single line segment, put the cursor on the starting point of the line. When the junction point between two line segments is erased, the line is redrawn connecting the line segments that were before and after the erased junction. See the figure below for an example. Erasing a line segment After erasing Erasing two lines After erasing Cursor location and line processing 5-6 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.5.2 Erasing all radar map marks and lines You can erase all radar map marks and lines from the screen as below. Be absolutely sure you want to erase all map marks and lines – erased marks and lines cannot be restored. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 5 [PLOTTER] to open the PLOTTER menu. 3. Select 8 [DATA ERASE]. [DATA ERASE] 1 BACK 2 OWN TRACK*1 RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT/ 30%/50%/80%/ALL 3 TARGET TRACK*2 RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT/ 30%/50%/80%/ALL 4 MARK ALL ERASE NO/YES 5 WPT ALL ERASE NO/YES 6 NAV LINE ALL ERASE NO/YES 7 OWN TRACK DELETE*3 2POINTS/AREA 8 TARGET TRACK DELETE*3 2POINTS/AREA *1 Colors not shown on IMO type *2 Not available on IMO type *3 Not available on IMO or A type DATA ERASE menu 4. Select 4 MARK ALL ERASE. 5. Select YES to erase all marks. 6. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 5-7 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.6 Radar Map Corrections 5.6.1 Radar map correction When there is positional error between the radar screen and radar map marks and lines, do the following to correct it. 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to display "CHART ALIGN L=OFF / EXIT" in the guidance box. 2. Operate the trackball to align the radar map with the radar screen. 3. Push the left button to set. "MAN ALIGNED" appears at the right side of the screen. To release the radar map correction, display "CHART ALIGN L=OFF / EXIT" in the guidance box then push the left button until "MAN ALIGNED" disappears from the screen. 5.6.2 Cursor data correction You can correct cursor data as below. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 5 [PLOTTER] to open the PLOTTER menu. [PLOTTER] 1 BACK 2 CHART COLOR* GRN/YEL/CYA ORANGE/GRAY 3 OWN TRACK INTERVAL OFF/DRAW/10S/30S/ 1M/2M/3M/6M/15M 4 OWN TRACK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT 5 TGT TRACK INTERVAL* OFF/DRAW/10S/30S/ 1M/2M/3M/6M/15M 6 TGT TRACK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT 7 CURSOR L/L ALIGN OFF/ON 8 [DATA ERASE] 9 [DISPLAY] 0 AUTO TARGET TRACK* OFF/ON * Not available on IMO type PLOTTER menu 3. Select 7 CURSOR L/L ALIGN. 5-8 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 4. Select ON. "ALIGN" appears (in light blue) next to cursor position in the text area if chart alignment has been done. To remove the correction, select OFF. If you are using the AIS function, select ON. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 5.7 Chart Cards (A, B, C and W types) FURUNO or NAVIONICS charts can be overlaid on the radar image when they are interfaced with the optional Card I/F Unit CU-200. CAUTION Handle chart cards and memory cards with care. Keep cards away from direct sunlight, heat sources, and active gases. Keep cards away from water and chemicals. Keep the connector free foreign material. Do not drop the cards. Chart cards are intended as an aid to navigation. The navigator has the responsibility to check all aids available to confirm position. 5.7.1 Displaying a chart To display a chart: 1. Insert a chart card in either of the two card slots in the Card I/F Unit CU-200. Card Slot Card slot location 2. Press the [POWER] button on the control unit to turn the power on. With the radar transmitting, select the radar display (NU, CU, TM modes only) or the radar/video plotter display to display the chart. To display a chart after the power has been turned on, change the range by pressing the [RANGE+] or [RANGE-] key or operating the RANGE box. 5-9 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.7.2 Chart position correction There may be a case where the chart overlay is not aligned with the radar image. This is due to an error in the position fixing system (GPS, Loran, etc.) or the different coordinates between the position fixing system and the radar. In this case, align the chart with the radar image as below. 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to display "CHART ALIGN L=OFF / EXIT" in the guidance box. 2. Operate the trackball to align the chart with the radar map. Note that track is neither recorded nor displayed at this point. 3. Push the left button to set. "CHART ALIGN" appears (in red) at the right side of the screen. To release the chart position correction, display "CHART ALIGN L=OFF / EXIT" in the guidance box then push the left button until "CHART ALIGN" disappears from the screen. 5.7.3 Correcting cursor data 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 5 [PLOTTER] to open the PLOTTER menu. [PLOTTER] 1 BACK 2 CHART COLOR* GRN/YEL/CYA ORANGE/GRAY 3 OWN TRACK INTERVAL OFF/DRAW/10S/30S/ 1M/2M/3M/6M/15M 4 OWN TRACK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT 5 TGT TRACK INTERVAL* OFF/DRAW/10S/30S/ 1M/2M/3M/6M/15M 6 TGT TRACK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT 7 CURSOR L/L ALIGN OFF/ON 8 [DATA ERASE] 9 [DISPLAY] 0 AUTO TARGET TRACK* OFF/ON * Not available on IMO type PLOTTER menu 3. Select 7 CURSOR L/L ALIGN. 4. Select ON. "ALIGN" appears (in red) next to cursor position in the cursor data box. (To remove the correction, select OFF. If you are using the AIS function, select ON.) 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 5-10 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.7.4 Chart land color (B, C and W types) You may select the color for the land on charts as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 5 [PLOTTER] to open the PLOTTER menu. [PLOTTER] 1 BACK 2 CHART COLOR* GRN/YEL/CYA ORANGE/GRAY 3 OWN TRACK INTERVAL OFF/DRAW/10S/30S/ 1M/2M/3M/6M/15M 4 OWN TRACK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT 5 TGT TRACK INTERVAL* OFF/DRAW/10S/30S/ 1M/2M/3M/6M/15M 6 TGT TRACK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT 7 CURSOR L/L ALIGN OFF/ON 8 [DATA ERASE] 9 [DISPLAY] 0 AUTO TARGET TRACK* OFF/ON * Not available on IMO type PLOTTER menu 3. Select 2 CHART COLOR. 4. Select color desired. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 5-11 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.8 Hiding, Showing Graphics on the Video Plotter Display 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 5 [PLOTTER] to open the PLOTTER menu. 3. Select 9 [DISPLAY]. Select an item. To go to page 2, select 0 NEXT. You may return to page 1 by choosing 1 BACK and pressing the scrollwheel or the left button. [DISPLAY (2/2)] [DISPLAY (1/2)] 1 BACK 2 GRID OFF/ L/L 3 OWN TRACK OFF/ON 4 TARGET TRACK* OFF/ON 5 MARK OFF/ON 6 LAND DENSITY* OFF/ON 7 PLACE NAME* OFF/ON 8 COAST LINE OFF/ON 9 CONTOUR LINE OFF/ON/DEPTH 0 NEXT Choose 0 NEXT to show page 2. 1 BACK 2 NAV LINE(MAP) OFF/ON 3 DANGER HIGHLIGHT OFF/ON 4 PROHIBITED AREA OFF/ON 5 BUOY OFF/ON Page 2 * Not available on IMO or A type Page 1 DISPLAY menus 4. Push the scrollwheel to select OFF or ON. Note: LAND DENSITY fills (ON) or hollows (OFF) land on an electronic chart. Land will be hollow when wrong card or wrong scale is used, regardless of LAND DENSITY setting. 5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to set other items. 6. Push the right button three or four times to close the menu depending on which page of the DISPLAY menu you are using. 5-12 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.9 Track 5.9.1 Plotting own ship’s track A total of 20,000 points are allotted for storage of own ship’s track, marks and lines. When this memory becomes full, the oldest track is deleted to make room for the latest. For that reason you may want to adjust the recording interval to conserve the memory. The table below shows the relation between plotting interval and maximum track recording time. Own track plotting interval and storage time Interval 10 s 30 s 1 min Max. Recording Time 55 hr 30 min 166 hr 40 min 13 days 21 hr 20 min Interval 2 min 3 min 6 min Max. Recording Time 27 days 18 hr 40 min 41 days 16 hr 83 days 8 hr 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 5 [PLOTTER] to open the PLOTTER menu. [PLOTTER] 1 BACK 2 CHART COLOR* GRN/YEL/CYA ORANGE/GRAY 3 OWN TRACK INTERVAL OFF/DRAW/10S/30S/ 1M/2M/3M/6M/15M 4 OWN TRACK COLOR RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT 5 TGT TRACK INTERVAL* OFF/DRAW/10S/30S/ 1M/2M/3M/6M/15M 6 TGT TRACK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT 7 CURSOR L/L ALIGN OFF/ON 8 [DATA ERASE] 9 [DISPLAY] 0 AUTO TARGET TRACK* OFF/ON * Not available on IMO type PLOTTER menu 3. Select 3 OWN TRACK INTERVAL. 4. Select appropriate option. Select OFF to stop plotting own ship’s track. DRAW displays the track but does not record it. Track is erased when the power is turned off or the range is changed. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 5-13 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.9.2 Plotting interval for other ships' tracks (A, B, C and W types) The tracks of 15 targets (other ships) can be recorded. The memory capacity for other ships’ track is 15,000 points (1,000 points per each of 15 targets). When the other ships’ track memory becomes full the oldest track is deleted to make room for the latest. For that reason you may want to adjust the recording interval to conserve the memory. The table below shows the relation between plotting interval and maximum track recording time for other ships’ track. Other target plot interval and storage time Interval 10 s 30 s 1 min 1. 2. 3. 4. Max. Recording Time 2 hrs 46 min 8 hrs 20 min 16 hrs 40 min Interval 2 min 3 min 6 min Max. Recording Time 66 hrs 20 min 50 hrs 100 hrs Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 5 [PLOTTER] to open the PLOTTER menu. Select 5 TGT TRACK INTERVAL. Select appropriate option. Select OFF to stop plotting own ship’s track. DRAW displays the track but does not record it. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 5-14 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.9.3 Auto target track (A, B, C and W types) You may display the track for up to 15 targets, automatically or manually. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 5.9.4 Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 5 [PLOTTER] to open the PLOTTER menu. Select 0 AUTO TARGET TRACK. Select OFF or ON as appropriate. ON: TT target number (1-15) automatically assigned to corresponding ship's track on the plotter display. OFF: The operator manually assigns target numbers to TT and AIS targets. Push the right button twice to close the menu. If you selected OFF at step 4, go to step 6 to assign a number to a track. Put the cursor inside the effective display then spin the scrollwheel to show TARGET TRACK ON/EXIT in the guidance area. Select the track of the TT or AIS target for which to assign target number then push the left button. Repeat step 7 to assign target numbers to other tracked targets, up to 15 targets. Push the right button to finish. Choosing track color (A, B, C and W types) 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 5 [PLOTTER] to open the PLOTTER menu. 3. Select 4 OWN TRACK COLOR or 6 TGT TRACK COLOR, whichever track color you want to set. 4. Select color desired. 5. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 5-15 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.9.5 Erasing track from the menu, on the screen The display may become full of track when, for example, own ship traces the same route several times or there are many tracks from other ships. You may erase track two ways: through the menu (by color or percentage) or directly on the screen (track between specified points is erased). Erasing track from the menu 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 5 [PLOTTER] to open the PLOTTER menu. 3. Select 8 [DATA ERASE]. [DATA ERASE] 1 BACK 2 OWN TRACK*1 RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT/ 30%/50%/80%/ALL 3 TARGET TRACK*2 RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT/ 30%/50%/80%/ALL 4 MARK ALL ERASE NO/YES 5 WPT ALL ERASE NO/YES 6 NAV LINE ALL ERASE NO/YES 7 OWN TRACK DELETE*3 2POINTS/AREA 8 TARGET TRACK DELETE*3 2POINTS/AREA *1 Colors not shown on IMO type *2 Not available on IMO type *3 Not available on IMO or A type DATA ERASE menu 4. Select 2 OWN TRACK or 3 TARGET TRACK (not available on IMO-type radar), whichever track you want to erase. 5. Select color (not available on IMO type) or percentage to erase. For example, "30" erases the oldest 30% of the track selected at step 4. Select "ALL" to erase all of the corresponding track. 6. Push the right button three times close the menu. 5-16 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.9.6 Erasing track with the cursor You may erase own ship track or any target’s track directly on the screen, by two points or area. Select the erasure method and then erase track. x: Specified point Erase track between two points Erase track within a specific range Choosing erasure method 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Left-click the MENU box. Select 5 [PLOTTER] and push the left button. Select 8 [DATA ERASE] and push the left button. Select 7 OWN TRACK DELETE and push the left button. Select 2POINTS or AREA as appropriate and push the left button. 2POINTS: Erase track between two points AREA: Erase all track within an area 6. Select appropriate option for 8 TARGET TRACK DELETE similarly. 7. Push the right button three times to close the menu. Erasing track between two points, area 1. Place the cursor inside the effective display area. 2. Spin the scrollwheel to show OWN TRACK DELETE/EXIT or TGT TRACK DELETE/EXIT in the guidance box at the bottom right-hand corner on the screen, whichever track you want to erase. 3. Use the trackball to place the cursor at the top-left corner of the area (or 1st point in case of erasure by two points) and push the left button. 4. Use the trackball to drag the cursor at the bottom-right corner of the area (or 2nd point in case of erasure by two points). If the erasure method (chosen on the previous page) is "AREA", a rectangle appears when you start dragging the cursor. 5. Push the left button to erase track. 6. Push the right button to quit. Note that this function is automatically canceled if there is no erasure occurring in 30 seconds. 5-17 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.10 Waypoints A particular location is known as a "waypoint," whether it be a starting point, a destination point or an intermediate point on a voyage. This unit can store 200 waypoints, numbered 001 to 200. Waypoints may be entered with the cursor, by manual input of latitude and longitude and at current position. 5.10.1 Entering waypoints Entering waypoints with the cursor 1. Use the trackball to select the MARK box at the left side of the screen. MARK > Mark type last selected, mark number 162.5°T 11.7NM Bearing and range from own ship to waypoint MARK box 2. Push the right button to open the MARK menu. [MARK MENU] 1 ORIGIN MARK STAB GND/SEA 2 MARK KIND ORIGIN MARK(No. )/ ORIGIN MARK(SYM)/ MAP MARK/ WP 1~50/ WP 51~ 100/ WP 101~150/ WP 151~198/ OWN SHIP SHAPE 8 MARK POSN CURSOR/OS/L/L 00°000.00 N 000°000.00 E 9 MAP DISPLAY OFF/ON 0 MAP MARK COLOR* RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT * Not available on IMO or A type MARK menu 3. Select 2 MARK KIND. 4. Select the WPT item which best matches the waypoint number you wish to enter. For example, if you want to enter waypoint number 59, select "WPT 51-100." 5. Push the right button to close the menu. The guidance box now reads "MARK SELECT / MARK MENU." 5-18 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 6. With the MARK box selected, roll the scrollwheel to display waypoint number desired then push the left button. The cursor jumps into the effective display area and the guidance box reads "MARK / EXIT." 7. Use the trackball to put the cursor where you want to inscribe a waypoint mark then push the left button to inscribe the mark. The waypoint mark (" " + waypoint number) appears at the location selected. (You can see the range and bearing to the cursor location by monitoring the mark range and bearing indication just below the MARK box.) • To enter another waypoint, push the right button when the guidance box reads "MARK / EXIT" then repeat steps 6-8. ("WPT" should be selected on the MARK menu.) • To quit entering waypoints, push the right button when the guidance box reads "MARK / EXIT." Entering waypoints by manual input of latitude and longitude 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT]. [NAV LINE•WPT (1/2)] 1 BACK 2 NAV LINE DATA OFF/EXT DATA/ INTERNAL DATA/ WPT MARK* 3 NAV LINE SELECT -FORWARD/REVERSE 4 SKIP NEXT WPT 5 NAV LINE WIDTH 9.99NM 6 [WPT SET] 7 [WPT LIST] 8 [NAV LINE SET] 9 [NAV LINE LIST] 0 NEXT * Not available on IMO type NAV LINE•WPT menu 3. Select 6 [WPT SET]. [WPT SET] 1 BACK 2 WPT NO. SELECT 001 3 WPT NAME WPT SET menu 4 WPT L/L _ _°_ _._ _ _ N _ _ _°_ _. _ _ _E 5 CLEAR DATA NO/YES 5-19 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 4. Select 2 WPT NO. SELECT. 5. Use the scrollwheel to select waypoint number: Select location then push the scrollwheel to set. 6. To enter waypoint name, follow the procedure below. If you do not require waypoint name go to step 7. e) Select 3 WPT NAME. f) Select alphanumeric character desired then push the scrollwheel. g) Repeat step 2 to complete the waypoint name. You may use up to 15 alphanumeric characters for waypoint name. 7. Select 4 WPT L/L. 8. Enter latitude and longitude position as follows: a) Select location desired then push the scrollwheel. (The scrollwheel may be pushed again to skip a place.) For input by keyboard, press appropriate numeric keys then press the [ENTER MARK] key. b) To switch co-ordinate polarity, roll the scrollwheel or use the [2] key in case of keyboard operation. 9. To enter another waypoint, repeat steps 4-8. 10. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 5.10.2 Editing, erasing waypoints from the menu You may edit or erase waypoints from the menu as follows. You cannot erase or edit a waypoint that is part of a route that is currently in use. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT]. Select 6 [WPT SET]. Select 2 WPT NO. SELECT. Use the scrollwheel to enter waypoint number you wish to edit. Then, do one of the following: • To change the waypoint name, Select 3 WPT NAME. Use the scrollwheel to edit waypoint name. • To edit the waypoint position, Select 4 WPT L/L. Use the scrollwheel to edit waypoint position. • To erase the waypoint, Select 5 CLEAR DATA. Note that a waypoint cannot be erased if it is part of a nav line. 6. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 5-20 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.10.3 Erasing waypoints Waypoints may be erased individually or collectively. Note that a waypoint cannot be erased if it is part of a nav line. Erasing individual waypoints 1. With the cursor inside the effective display area, roll the scrollwheel to display "MARK DELETE / EXIT" in the guidance box. 2. Use the trackball to put the cursor on the waypoint you wish to erase. A flashing "+" appears on the mark when it is correctly selected. 3. Push the left button or the scrollwheel to erase the waypoint. 4. To erase another waypoint, repeat steps 2 and 3. 5. To finish, push the right button when the guidance reads "MARK DELETE / EXIT". Erasing all waypoints 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 5 [PLOTTER] to open the PLOTTER menu. 3. Select 8 [DATA ERASE]. [DATA ERASE] 1 BACK 2 OWN TRACK*1 RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT/ 30%/50%/80%/ALL 3 TARGET TRACK*2 RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT/ 30%/50%/80%/ALL 4 MARK ALL ERASE NO/YES 5 WPT ALL ERASE NO/YES 6 NAV LINE ALL ERASE NO/YES 7 OWN TRACK DELETE*3 2POINTS/AREA 8 TARGET TRACK DELETE*3 2POINTS/AREA *1 Colors not shown on IMO type *2 Not available on IMO type *3 Not available on IMO or A type DATA ERASE menu 4. Select 5 WPT ALL ERASE. 5. Select YES to erase all waypoints. 6. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 5-21 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.10.4 Waypoint list The waypoint list stores position data of all registered waypoints. Each page of the waypoint list holds eight waypoints. To display the waypoint list: 1. Right-click the MENU box at the right side of the screen to open the menu. 2. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT] to open the NAV LINE•WPT menu. 3. Select 7 [WPT LIST]. Asterisks indicate no data. [WPT LIST (1/25)] 1 BACK (L=TOP) 001 WP1 34°42.110 N 136°31.580 E 002 WP2 33°97.690 N 134°64.350 E 003 004 005 006 007 008 0 NEXT (L=LAST) WPT list 4. To go to a next page, select 0 NEXT. 5. Push the right button several times to close the waypoint list and the menu. 5-22 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.10.5 Displaying waypoint name and number You may turn waypoint name and number display on or off as desired. 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT]. 3. Select 0 NEXT. [NAV LINE•WPT (2/2)] 1 BACK 2 ARRIVAL WPT ALARM OFF/ON 3 TURNING LINE OFF/ON/REVISED 4 DISP WPT NO. OFF/ON 5 DISP WPT NAME OFF/ON 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. NAV LINE•WPT menu (2/2) Select 4 DISP WPT NO.. Select OFF or ON as appropriate. Select 5 DISP WPT NAME. Select OFF or ON as appropriate. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 5-23 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.11 Nav Lines 30 nav lines may be entered, and each line may have up to 30 waypoints. 5.11.1 Entering a new nav line To enter a nav line, first enter appropriate waypoints. Then, do the following: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT]. 3. Select 8 [NAV LINE SET]. [NAV LINE SET] 1 BACK 2 NAV LINE NO. SELECT 01 3 NAV LINE NAME 4 NAV LINE ENTRY — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 5 CLEAR DATA NO/YES NAV LINE SET menu 4. Select 2 NAV LINE NO. SELECT. 5. Use the scrollwheel to enter nav line no., in two digits. 6. Select 3 NAV LINE NAME. 7. Use the scrollwheel to enter a name. 8. Select 4 NAV LINE ENTRY. 9. Use the scrollwheel to enter waypoint numbers (in three digits): Select numeral and push it to set. 10. To enter another nav line, select 0 BACK to return to the NAV LINE SET menu then repeat steps 4-9. 11. To finish, push the right button several times to close the menu. 5-24 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.11.2 Editing a nav line Follow the procedure below to edit a nav line. Before editing a nav line it must be disabled. See section 5.11.6. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT]. Select 8 [NAV LINE SET]. Select 2 NAV LINE NO. SELECT. Use the scrollwheel to enter nav line number to edit. To edit nav line name, Select 3 NAV LINE NAME. Use the scrollwheel to change name. 7. To replace waypoints in a nav line, do the following: 1) Select 4 [NAV DATA ENTRY]. 2) Push the scrollwheel to select the waypoint you wish to replace. 3) Roll the scrollwheel to set new waypoint number. To delete the waypoint from the nav line, enter "000". 4) Push the scrollwheel to finish. 8. Push the right button several times to close the menu. 5-25 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.11.3 Nav line list The nav line list, which shows all nav lines registered, may be displayed as follows: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT]. 3. Select 9 [NAV LINE LIST]. [NAV LINE LIST (1/30)] 1 BACK (L=TOP) 01 LINE 1 001—002—003 004—005—006 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 0 NEXT (L=LAST) NAV LINE LIST 4. To go to a next page select 0 NEXT. To return to a previous page, select 1 BACK. 5. Push the right button as many times as necessary to close the menu. 5-26 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.11.4 Erasing a nav line 30 nav lines may be entered. You may erase unnecessary nav lines as shown below. A nav line that is currently in use cannot be erased. Erasing individual nav lines 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT]. 3. Select 8 [NAV LINE SET]. [NAV LINE SET] 1 BACK 2 NAV LINE NO. SELECT 01 3 NAV LINE NAME 4 NAV LINE ENTRY — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 5 CLEAR DATA NO/YES 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. NAV LINE SET menu Select 2 NAV LINE NO. SELECT. Use the scrollwheel to enter nav line no., in two digits. Select 5 CLEAR DATA. Push the scrollwheel or the left button to delete the nav line. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 5-27 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION Erasing all nav lines 1. Left-click the MENU box. 2. Select 5 [PLOTTER]. 3. Select 8 [DATA ERASE]. [DATA ERASE] 1 BACK 2 OWN TRACK*1 RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT/ 30%/50%/80%/ALL 3 TARGET TRACK*2 RED/GRN/BLU/YEL/ CYA/MAG/WHT/ 30%/50%/80%/ALL 4 MARK ALL ERASE NO/YES 5 WPT ALL ERASE NO/YES 6 NAV LINE ALL ERASE NO/YES 7 OWN TRACK DELETE*3 2POINTS/AREA 8 TARGET TRACK DELETE*3 2POINTS/AREA *1 Colors not shown on IMO type *2 Not available on IMO type *3 Not available on IMO or A type DATA ERASE menu 4. Select 6 NAV LINE ALL ERASE. 5. Select YES to erase all nav lines and their data. 6. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 5.11.5 Setting up nav lines Nav lines can be set up as follows: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Left-click the MENU box. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT]. Select 2 NAV LINE DATA. Select INTERNAL DATA. Select 5 NAV LINE WIDTH. Use the scrollwheel to enter the width for the nav line, from 0.0-9.99(nm). A pair of orange lines mark the width of the nav line. * Not available on IMO type [NAV LINE•WPT (1/2)] 1 BACK 2 NAV LINE DATA OFF/EXT DATA/ INTERNAL DATA/ WPT MARK* 3 NAV LINE SELECT -FORWARD/REVERSE 4 SKIP NEXT WPT 5 NAV LINE WIDTH 0.00NM 6 [WPT SET] 7 [WPT LIST] 8 [NAV LINE SET] 9 [NAV LINE LIST] 0 NEXT NAV LINE•WPT menu (1/2) 5-28 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 7. If you want to be alerted when own ship nears a waypoint by a preset distance, select 0 NEXT then push the scrollwheel. [NAV LINE•WPT (2/2)] 1 BACK 2 ARRIVAL WPT ALARM OFF/ON 0.19NM 3 TURNING LINE OFF/ON/REVISED 4 DISP WPT NO. OFF/ON 5 DISP WPT NAME OFF/ON NAV LINE•WPT menu (2/2) 8. Select ARRIVAL WPT ALARM. 9. Select ON. 10. Select 3 TURNING LINE. 11. Select appropriate option. OFF: Turns turning lines off. ON: Use this setting when the vessel is not to correct cross track error to return to course set, after arriving at turning line location. REVISED: Use this setting when vessel is to return to course set after correcting cross track error, after arriving at turning line location. Note: Before using the turning line feature, set the Trial Maneuver function as appropriate, on the TT●AIS menu. No cross track error correction at turning line Cross track error correction at turning line Nav line Course Turning line Turning line Own ship Track TURNING LINE: ON TURNING LINE: REVISED Turning line 12. Push the right button three times to close the menu. 5-29 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.11.6 Displaying nav line, waypoint mark Displaying internal nav lines 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT]. Select 2 NAV LINE DATA. Select INTERNAL DATA. Select 3 NAV LINE SELECT. Use the scrollwheel to enter the nav line number you want to display. Select numeral and push it to set. Note that the same nav line no. cannot be entered more than once. 7. Use FORWARD or REVERSE to select the order to display waypoints on the nav line. FORWARD to display them in original order or REVERSE to display them in reverse order. Select appropriate option then push the scrollwheel. 8. To skip the next waypoint, Select 2 SKIP NEXT WPT. 9. Push the right button twice to close the menu. Displaying external nav lines Nav lines from an external navigator can be displayed as below. RTE and WPL sentences are necessary to display a nav line from a navigator. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT]. Select 2 NAV LINE DATA. Select EXT DATA. Do the following as appropriate: 1) Set width (0.0-9.9 nm) of the nav line with 5 NAV LINE WIDTH. 2) Turn waypoint number display on or off with 4 DSP WPT NO (page 2 of NAV LINE•WPT menu). 3) Set turning line with 3 TURNING LINE (page 2 of NAV LINE•WPT menu). 6. Push the right button two or three times depending on which page of the NAV LINE•WPT menu you are using. 5-30 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION Waypoint mark (A, B, C and W types only) The waypoint mark shows the location of a destination waypoint that is set on a navigator. You may mark this location on the radar display by following the procedure shown below. 330 340 350 000 010 020 030 Waypoint Mark 040 320 050 310 060 300 070 290 280 080 090 270 260 100 250 110 240 120 230 130 140 220 210 200 150 190 180 170 160 Waypoint mark 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 8 [NAV LINE•WPT]. Select 2 NAV LINE DATA. Select WPT MARK. Push the right button twice to close the menu. 5-31 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.12 Recording Data The optional Card I/F Unit CU-200 is required to record or replay data. The CU-200 has two card slots and you can connect two units, for a total of four card slots. 5.12.1 Initializing memory (RAM) cards Before you can use a memory (RAM) card it must be initialized. Formatting prepares the recording surface of the card for use with the system, and deletes all data recorded in the memory card. You can format cards you’ve used before, however, in which case all prior information on them is erased. 1. Insert a blank memory card into the appropriate card slot in the Card I/F Unit. Card Slot Card I/F unit, front view 2. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 3. Select 6 [CARD]. (Note that "WR" in the CARD menu means "Write.") [CARD (1/2)] 1 BACK 2 DRIVE SELECT A/B/C/D* 3 [READ CARD] 4 [WR MARK] 5 [WR NAV LINE•WPT] 6 [WR OWN TRACK] 7 [WR TARGET TRACK]** 8 [WR SETTING DATA] 9 [WR INSTALL DATA] 0 NEXT * Drives available are shown. ** Not available on IMO type CARD menu, page 1 4. Select 2 DRIVE SELECT. 5. Select appropriate drive. Note: If one unit is connected the drives are, from the left drive on the unit, A=1 and B=2. In case of a second drive unit, its drives are, from the left drive on the unit, C=1 and D=2. One Unit 5-32 2nd Unit 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 6. Select 0 NEXT. [CARD (2/2)] 1 BACK 2 [FILE DELETE] 3 [CARD INITIALIZE] CARD menu, page 2 7. Select 3 CARD INITIALIZE. [CARD INITIALIZE] 1 BACK 2 INITIALIZE START NO/YES CARD INITIALIZE menu 8. Select 2 INITIALIZE START to initialize the card. The LED near the card flashes, the CARD menu disappears and the message "FORMAT CARD DATA" appears. 5.12.2 Recording data When the memory becomes full, the oldest track is erased to make room for the latest. Further, when the memory is full you cannot enter another mark or line unless you erase unnecessary marks, lines or track. Thus you should save important data to a memory card so as not to lose important data. 1. Insert initialized memory card into appropriate drive in Card I/F Unit. 2. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 3. Select 6 [CARD]. [CARD (1/2)] 1 BACK 2 DRIVE SELECT A/B/C/D* 3 [READ CARD] 4 [WR MARK] 5 [WR NAV LINE•WPT] 6 [WR OWN TRACK] 7 [WR TARGET TRACK]** 8 [WR SETTING DATA] 9 [WR INSTALL DATA] 0 NEXT * Drives available are shown. ** Not available on IMO type CARD menu 5-33 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 4. Select DRIVE SELECT. 5. Select appropriate drive. 6. Select data to record (one item among 4-9). For example select 4 WR MARK. The display then looks something like the one below. [WR MARK] 1 BACK 2 NAME (See note below.) M0000000 CARD WRITE menu Note: The file name is composed of a single alphabet, the file type, and seven alphanumeric characters, the file number. The file type is denoted as follows: M: Radar map mark (20,000 points) W: Waypoint, nav line (Waypoint, 20 points, nav line, 30 lines) T: Own track (20,000 points) A: Target track (1,000 points x 15 targets) S: Setting data (all operating information other than initial settings) I: Installation data (initial settings) 7. Use the scrollwheel and the left button to enter file name. You may use up to seven alphanumeric characters. 8. After entering the last digit of the file name the selected item is recorded. The message "WR CARD DATA" is shown during recording. 5-34 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION 5.13 Replaying Data Video plotter data (track, marks, etc.) may be replayed on the screen. This is useful for analyzing past data. 1. Insert memory card into the appropriate slot in an I/F card unit. 2. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 3. Select 6 [CARD]. [CARD (1/2)] 1 BACK 2 DRIVE SELECT A/B/C/D* 3 [READ CARD] 4 [WR MARK] 5 [WR NAV LINE•WPT] 6 [WR OWN TRACK] 7 [WR TARGET TRACK]** 8 [WR SETTING DATA] 9 [WR INSTALL DATA] 0 NEXT * Drives available are shown. ** Not available on IMO type CARD menu 4. 5. 6. 7. Select 2 DRIVE SELECT. Select the drive where you inserted the memory card. Push the left button. Select 3 READ CARD and push the scrollwheel or the left button. [READ CARD (1/2)] 1 BACK 2 T200304109 9 W200307318 0 NEXT READ CARD menu 8. Select the data to replay. 9. Push the left button to replay selected data. The message "RD CARD DATA" is shown during playback. If you selected WR INSTALL DATA, the prompt "POWER ON RESET" appears; turn the power off and on again to read in installation data. 5-35 5. VIDEO PLOTTER OPERATION Note: Marks, own ship’s track and other ships’ tracks replayed from a memory card are added to the data currently displayed. If, at replay, the memory is full, the message "MEMORY ERROR" appears. Press the [ALARM ACK] key to erase the message. Memory capacity is as shown below. Mark: 20,000 points Own ship's track: 20,000 points Other ships’ tracks: 1,000 points x 15 targets 5.14 Deleting Files 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. Select 6 [CARD]. Select 2 DRIVE SELECT. Select the appropriate drive. Select 0 NEXT. [CARD] 1 BACK 2 FILE DELETE 3 CARD INITIALIZE CARD menu, page 2 6. Select 2 FILE DELETE. [FILE DELETE (1/1)] BACK T2003410 W2003126 A20035311 S20030129 S20030118 FILE DELETE display 7. Select the file to delete. The message "DELETE CARD DATA" appears while data is being deleted. 5-36 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING Periodic checks and maintenance are important for proper operation of any electronic system. This chapter contains maintenance and troubleshooting instructions to be followed to obtain optimum performance and the longest possible life of the equipment. Before attempting any maintenance or troubleshooting procedure please review the safety information below. WARNING Do not open the equipment. Hazardous voltage which can cause electrical shock exists inside the equipment. Only qualified personnel should work inside the equipment. Turn off the radar power switch before servicing the antenna unit. Post a warning sign near the switch indicating it should not be turned on while the antenna unit is being serviced. Prevent the potential risk of being struck by the rotating antenna. A transmitting radar antenna emits electromagnetic waves, which can be harmful, particularly the eyes. Wear a safety belt and hard hat when working on the antenna unit. Serious injury or death can result if someone falls from the radar antenna mast. NOTICE Do not apply paint, anti-corrosive sealant or contact spray to coating or plastic parts of the equipment. Those items contain organic solvents that can damage coating and plastic parts, especially plastic connectors. 6-1 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING 6.1 Periodic Maintenance Schedule Regular maintenance is essential to good performance. A regular maintenance program should be established and should at least include the items shown in the table below. Maintenance schedule Interval When needed 3 to 6 months Check point Remarks The LCD will in time accumulate a layer of dust which tends to dim the picture Wipe the LCD carefully to Do not use chemical-based prevent scratching, using cleaners to clean the LCD. They tissue paper and an LCD can damage the LCD coating. cleaner. To remove stubborn dirt, use an LCD cleaner, wiping slowly with tissue paper so as to dissolve the dirt. Change paper frequently so the dirt will not scratch the LCD. Processor unit cleanliness Dust and dirt may be removed with a soft cloth. Do not use chemical-based cleaners to clean the processor unit. They can remove paint and markings. Exposed nuts and Check for corroded or bolts on antenna loosened nuts and bolts. If unit necessary, clean and repaint them thickly. Replace them if heavily corroded. Sealing compound may be used instead of paint. Apply a small amount of grease between nuts and bolts for easy removal in future. Antenna radiator Check for dirt and cracks on radiator surface. Thick dirt should be wiped off with soft cloth dampened with fresh water. If a crack is found, apply a slight amount of sealing compound or adhesive as a temporary remedy, then call for repair. Do not use chemical-based cleaners for cleaning. They can remove paint and markings. If you need to remove ice from the antenna unit, use a wooden hammer or plastic head hammer. Crack on the unit may cause water ingress, causing serious damages to internal circuits. Terminal strips and plugs in antenna unit (TECHNICIANS only) Open antenna cover to check terminal strip and plug connections inside. Also check the rubber gasket of antenna covers for deterioration. When closing antenna covers in position, be careful not to catch loose wires between covers and unit. 6 months to Terminal strips, one year sockets, earth terminal on processor unit (TECHNICIANS only) 6-2 Check and measures Check for loose connections. Check contacts and plugs for proper seating, etc. 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING 6.2 Life Expectancy of Major Parts Parts Type Life expectancy Remarks Antenna Motor D8G-516 (24 rpm, X-band) Gear motor D8G-571 (42 rpm, X-band) 10,000 h GOB-8222 (18/22 rpm, X-band) RM-6585 (22 rpm, X-band) RM-7398 (21/26 rpm, S-band) RM-7435 (21/26 rpm, S-band) RM-9519 (45 rpm, S-band) RM-9520 (45 rpm, S-band) RM-9520 (45 rpm, S-band) Carbon brush MG120-5X6X11 D8G (X-band) 2,000 h Check for wear when replacing magnetron. Replace if worn. Magnetron MAF-1565N (X-band, 12 kW) MG4010 (X-band, 12 kW) MG5436 (X-band, 25 kW) MG5223F (S-band, 30 kW) 4,000 h 4,000 h 4,000 h 7,000 h Check no. of hours used at Tx time. Reset time after replacement. Backlight Unit for Display Unit MU-201CR 201LHS2F 45,000 h (25°C) 30,000 h (50°C) Replace when brilliance is uneven or too low. Cold Cathode Fluorescent Lamp for Display Unit MU-231CR FLCL-23 50,000 h (25°C) 35,000 h (50°C) Replace when brilliance is uneven or too low. LCD assy. (MU-170C) 856JAU1745V3 40,000 h The life expectancy figures are typical values. Actual life depends on usage. 6-3 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING 6.3 Replacing the Fuse The fuse at the rear of the processor unit and the display unit protects the equipment from overcurrent and equipment fault. If you cannot turn on the power, first check the fuse. Find the cause of the trouble before replacing the fuse. WARNING Use the proper fuse. Use of a wrong fuse can result in damage to the equipment or cause fire. Ship’s mains and fuse to use Unit Power Fuse to use 24 VDC 20A 100-115 VAC 10A 220-230 VAC 5A 100-230 VAC 2A 24 VDC 5A 100-230 VAC 2A 24 VDC 6A 12 VDC 10A 24 VDC 5A Display Unit MU-231 100-230 VAC 1.5A Display Unit MU-190 100-230 VAC 1A Processor Unit Display Unit MU-201CR Display Unit MU-231CR Display Unit MU-170C 6.4 Replacement of Battery on GC Board The battery installed on the GC (GyroCompass) Board inside the processor unit preserves gyro data when the power is turned off. The life of the battery is about five years. When the battery voltage is low, NG appears at the diagnostic test for the GC Board. When this occurs, contact your dealer for replacement. Battery on GC Board Location of battery GC board 6-4 Battery type CR 1/2 8.L Code number 000-103-769 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING 6.5 Trackball Maintenance If the cursor skips or moves abnormally, clean the trackball as below. 1. Turn the retaining ring counterclockwise 45° to unlock it. Retaining Ring 2. Remove the retaining ring and ball. 3. Clean the ball with a soft, lint-free cloth, then blow carefully into the ball-cage to dislodge dust and lint. 4. Look for a build-up of dirt on the metal rollers. If dirty, clean the rollers using a cotton swab moistened lightly with isopropyl-rubbing alcohol. 5. Make sure that fluff from the swab is not left on the rollers. 6. Replace the ball and retaining ring. Be sure the retaining ring is not inserted reversely. 6-5 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING 6.6 Easy Troubleshooting This section provides troubleshooting procedures that the user may follow to restore normal operation. If you cannot restore normal operation, do not attempt to check inside any unit. Any repair work is best left to a qualified technician. Easy troubleshooting procedures Problem Key beep inaudible Cause Key beep turned off Adjust key beep level on the OPERATION menu, referring to section 1.43. Picture not updated or Video freeze picture freeze. 30 seconds after the picture freezes, the buzzer sounds, the [ALARM ACK] key blinks and alarm signal is output. Power is ON but nothing appears on monitor. Remedy Turn the power off and on again to restore normal operation. Brilliance is too low. Keyboard-type control unit: Turn BRILL control clockwise to increase the brilliance. Trackball-type control unit: Press any one of F1-F4 for five seconds to increase the brilliance to "50". Reset the power to restore normal operation. Marks, indications and Tx high voltage noise appear but no protection circuit has echo activated. Range changed but Defective range key Try to hit RANGE [+] and [-] keys (or RANGE box) radar picture does not or video freeze up several times. (If unsuccessful, replacement of change keypad may be required in case of the keyboard-type control unit.) If that does not work try to turn the power off and on again to see if the problem might be video freeze up. Only 2 PI lines when 6 Incorrect setting of lines are wanted PI line interval Incorrect setting of PI line interval. Adjust PI line interval, referring to section 1.31.2. Also, the setting for number of PI lines to display may be inappropriate. Check the menu setting for number of PI lines, referring to section 1.31.4. Range rings are not displayed Range rings turned off Try turning on the range rings with 0 RINGS in the MARK menu. If they do not appear, their brilliance may be too low. Adjust their brilliance at page 1 of the BRILL menu. Tracked target not tracked correctly Poor definition of Adjust A/C SEA and A/C RAIN referring to section targets in sea clutter 1.17 and 1.18. Tuning adjusted but poor sensitivity 2nd trace echo • Turn off the 2nd trace echo rejector, referring to rejector on or dirt on section 1.38. radiator face • Clean the radiator face. 6-6 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING 6.7 Advanced-level Troubleshooting This section describes how to cure hardware and software troubles that should be carried out by qualified service personnel. Note 1: This radar equipment contains complex modules in which fault diagnosis and repair down to component level are not practicable by users. Note 2: When replacement of the SPU board is necessary, the previous settings can be transferred to new SPU board as follows: - Use the CU-200 to save settings to a RAM card. - After replacing the SPU board, load the entire contents of the RAM card to the radar, referring to section 5.12 for the procedure. Advanced troubleshooting Problem Probable causes or check Remedy points Power turned on but radar 1) Blown fuse. does not operate at all 2) Mains voltage/polarity 1) Replace blown fuse. 2) Correct wiring and input voltage. 3) Power supply board 3) Replace power supply board. Brilliance adjusted but no picture SPU board Replace SPU board. Antenna not rotating 1) Antenna drive mechanism 1) Replace antenna drive mechanism. 2) Defective antenna drive 2) Press relay reset button. motor relay (thermal relay K2, 200/220/380, 440/100 VAC) Data and marks not displayed in Transmit status SPU board Adjust GAIN with A/C SEA 1) IF amplifier set at minimum. Marks and 2) Signal cable between indications appear but no antenna and processor noise or echo unit 3) Video amplifier board Replace SPU board. 1) Replace IF amplifier. 2) Check continuity and isolation of coaxial cable. Note: Disconnect the plug and lugs at both ends of coaxial cable before checking it by ohmmeter. 3) Check video coax line for secure connection. If connection is good, replace SPU board. (Continued on next page) 6-7 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING Advanced troubleshooting (con’t) Problem Probable causes or check Remedy points Marks, indications and noise appear but no echo (Transmission leak representing own ship position is absent) 1) TX high voltage protection circuit has activated. 1) Reset power to restore normal operation. 2) Magnetron 2) Check magnetron current. Replace magnetron. 3) Modulator board 3) Replace modulator board. 4) SPU board 4) Replace SPU board. Picture not updated or picture freeze-up Incorrect orientation of picture 1) Bearing signal generator 1) Check the connection of signal cables. board (in antenna unit) 2) SPU board 2) Replace SPU board. 3) Video freeze-up 3) Turn off and on the radar. 1) SPU board 1) The message HDG SIG MISSING appears when the heading pulse is not received during transmitting. 2) Gyro interface 2) Replace the gyro interface. Cannot operate radar from SPU Board on-screen boxes Replace SPU Board. Radar is properly tuned but 1) Deteriorated magnetron 1) With the radar transmitting on 48 nm poor sensitivity range, check magnetron current. If current is below normal, magnetron may be defective. Replace it. Range changed but radar picture not changing 2) Detuned MIC 2) Check MIC detecting current. If it is below normal value, MIC may have become detuned. MIC must be tuned. 3) Dirt on radiator face 4) Water ingress to the waveguide or other feeder line 5) Second trace echo rejection is ON 3) Clean the radiator surface. 4) Remove water from the feeder line. 1) Defective range key 1) Try to hit RANGE [+] and [-] keys several times. If unsuccessful, replacement of keypad may be required. 2) SPU board 2) Replace SPU board. 3) Video freeze up 3) Turn off and on radar. (Continued on next page) 6-8 5) Disable the second-trace echo rejector referring to section 1.38. 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING Advanced troubleshooting (con’t) Problem Probable causes or check Remedy points Interference rejector is inoperative (interference rejection level not displayed) SPU board Replace SPU board. Echo stretch is ineffective SPU board (neither ES1, ES2 nor ES3 is displayed) Replace SPU board. Range rings are not displayed 1) Adjust the brilliance of range rings on the BRILL menu to see if intensity is increased 1) Replace associated circuit board if unsuccessful. 2) SPU board 2) Replace SPU board. Poor discrimination in range Sea clutter control not functioning properly Improper setting of A/C SEA. If A/C SEA is seen only at very close range, suspect inaccurate frequency of reference oscillator. True motion presentation not working correctly 1) Poor contact of MODE key (full keyboard) 1) Try to press MODE key a little harder. 2) Selection not accessed. 2) Press MODE key or operate PRESENTATION MODE box until TM appears. 3) Speed entry incorrect 3) Enter correct own ship speed referring to section 1.13. 4) TM display inaccurate 4) Make sure that speed and compass inputs are accurate. Target not tracked correctly Poor definition of targets in Adjust A/C SEA and A/C RAIN controls sea clutter referring to section 1.17 and 1.18. Buttons on trackball module operated but no response Trackball module Replace trackball module. 6-9 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING 6.8 Diagnostics A diagnostic test program is provided to test major circuit boards in the control unit, processor unit and card I/F unit. Note that the normal radar picture is lost during this test. Proceed as follows to execute the diagnostic test: 1. Left-click the MENU box to open the menu. 2. Select 9 [CUSTOMIZE•TEST]. [CUSTOMIZE•TEST] BACK [DATA BOX] [F1] [F2] [F3] [F4] [OPERATION] [TEST] CUSTOMIZE•TEST menu 3. Select 8 [TEST]. [TEST] 1 BACK 2 [SELF TEST] 3 [TT TEST] TEST menu 4. Select 2 [SELF TEST] . [SELF TEST] 1 BACK 2 START SELF TEST menu 5. Select 2 START to start the test. In a few moments the results of the test are displayed and the buzzer sounds continuously. The ROMs and RAMs of the SPU, RFC, KEYBOARD (Control Unit), REMOTE (Trackball-only Control Unit) and CARD I/F UNIT are checked for proper operation. OK appears for normal operation. If NG (No Good) appears, corresponding components may be defective. Consult your dealer. In the middle of the display the rpm of the antenna unit and various voltages are displayed. 6-10 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTINGPROGRAM No. SPU 0359204-03.** RFC 0359202-01.** KEY 0359203-01.** REMOTE1 0359203-01.** REMOTE2 # CARD 0359209-01.** ROM OK OK OK OK RAM OK OK OK OK DIP SW 0000 OK OK 0000 PROCESSOR UNIT MONITOR -12V -11.6 3.3V 3.3 5V 4.9 12V 11.6 SCANNER MOTOR 20.7 RF UNIT MONITOR TEMPERATURE TUNE IND HV R. MONITOR MAG. CURRENT HEATER 12V -12V 5V 32V TUNE OUT TRIGGER FREQ ANT SPEED 27.3 1.4 527.9 1.6 1.5 1.8 11.9 -11.8 4.8 31.8 19.2 2273 21.6 *.**: Program Version No. #: Installed card units are shown. Self test results, keyboard test 6. The small squares and circles displayed at the bottom of screen are for testing the control and keys on the control unit. As you operate controls and keys, corresponding squares are highlighted, indicating that your control/key operations are properly recognized. Numerals indicate the position of the controls under check. 6-11 6. MAINTENANCE, TROUBLESHOOTING 7. Press the [F1] key to change the display. The buzzer stops and the screen shows the sentences being input from external equipment (GPS1, GPS2SPEED, HEADING and NAV DATA). Below is an example. The sentences shown depend on your system settings. GGA GLL RMC RMB VTG ZDA DTM BWR BWC GGA GLL RMC RMB VTG ZDA DTM BWR BWC VBW VHW VDR HDT
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.6 Linearized : Yes XMP Toolkit : Adobe XMP Core 4.0-c321 44.398116, Tue Aug 04 2009 14:24:39 Producer : Acrobat Distiller 7.0.5 (Windows) Create Date : 2011:01:26 15:32:12+09:00 Creator Tool : PScript5.dll Version 5.2 Modify Date : 2011:02:17 17:18:34+09:00 Metadata Date : 2011:02:17 17:18:34+09:00 Format : application/pdf Creator : dmills Title : Microsoft Word - FAR2xx7 OME.doc Document ID : uuid:87989e61-31e7-4306-8d1b-3a2dcb613d68 Instance ID : uuid:4fe8f43a-72f7-4dae-bbad-ede4466511e7 Has XFA : No Page Count : 309 Author : dmillsEXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools